blob: 2cb92b6db68a4de0600869668944c3666eea35d4 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000100 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
101 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
102 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
103
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000104 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000105}
106
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000107/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000109/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
110///
111void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000112 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000113 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000116
117 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
118 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000119 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
120 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000122 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
123 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000124 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000125 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
126 int isMethod = 0;
127 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
128 // skip over named parameters.
129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
130 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
131 if (nullPos)
132 --nullPos;
133 else
134 ++i;
135 }
136 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
137 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 // skip over named parameters.
140 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
141 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
142 if (nullPos)
143 --nullPos;
144 else
145 ++i;
146 }
147 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000149 // block or function pointer call.
150 QualType Ty = V->getType();
151 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000153 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
154 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
156 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
157 unsigned k;
158 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
159 if (nullPos)
160 --nullPos;
161 else
162 ++i;
163 }
164 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
165 }
166 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
167 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000168 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000169 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000170 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 return;
172
173 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000176 return;
177 }
178 int sentinel = i;
179 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
180 --sentinelPos;
181 ++i;
182 }
183 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
184 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000185 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000186 return;
187 }
188 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
189 ++i;
190 ++sentinel;
191 }
192 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
194 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
195 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Anders Carlsson343e6ff2010-11-05 15:21:33 +0000196
197 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
198 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return;
199
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000200 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000201 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
202 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
203 return;
204
205 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
206 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
207
208 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
209 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000210}
211
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000212SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
213 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
214 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
215}
216
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
218// Standard Promotions and Conversions
219//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
220
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000221/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
222void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
223 QualType Ty = E->getType();
224 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
225
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000226 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000227 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000228 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000229 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
230 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
231 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
232 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
233 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
234 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
235 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000236 //
237 // C++ 4.2p1:
238 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
239 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
240 //
241 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
242 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000243 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000244 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000245 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000246}
247
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000248void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
249 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000250
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000251 QualType Ty = E->getType();
252 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
253 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
254 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
255 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
256 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
257 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
258 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
259 // rvalue is T
260 //
261 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000262 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
263 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000264 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000265 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000266 }
267}
268
269
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000270/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000271/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000272/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
273/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
274/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
275Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
276 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
277 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000279 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
280 //
281 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
282 // unsigned int may be used:
283 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
284 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
285 // and unsigned int.
286 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
287 //
288 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
289 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
290 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
291 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000292 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
293 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000294 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000295 return Expr;
296 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000297 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000298 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000299 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000300 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000301 }
302
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000303 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000304 return Expr;
305}
306
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000307/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000308/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000309/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
310void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
311 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
312 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000313
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000314 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000315 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
316 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000317 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000318
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000319 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
320}
321
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000322/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
323/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
324/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
325/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000326bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
327 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000328 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000329
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000330 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
331 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
332 // etc.
333 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
334 return false;
335
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000336 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000337 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
338 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
339 << Expr->getType() << CT))
340 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000341
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000342 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000343 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000344 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
345 << Expr->getType() << CT))
346 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000347
348 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000349}
350
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000351/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
352/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000353/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000354/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
355/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
356/// GCC.
357QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
358 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000359 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000360 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000361
362 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000364 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000365 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000366 QualType lhs =
367 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000368 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000369 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000370
371 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
372 if (lhs == rhs)
373 return lhs;
374
375 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
376 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
377 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
378 return lhs;
379
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000380 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
381 QualType lhs_unpromoted = lhs;
382 if (lhs->isPromotableIntegerType())
383 lhs = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(lhs);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000384 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000385 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
386 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000387 if (lhs != lhs_unpromoted && !isCompAssign)
388 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000389
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000390 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
391 if (lhs == rhs)
392 return lhs;
393
394 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
395
396 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
397 bool LHSComplexFloat = lhs->isComplexType();
398 bool RHSComplexFloat = rhs->isComplexType();
399 if (LHSComplexFloat || RHSComplexFloat) {
400 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type.
401
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000402 if (!RHSComplexFloat && !rhs->isRealFloatingType()) {
403 if (rhs->isIntegerType()) {
404 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(lhs)->getElementType();
405 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, fp, CK_IntegralToFloating);
406 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
407 } else {
408 assert(rhs->isComplexIntegerType());
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000409 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000410 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000411 return lhs;
412 }
413
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000414 if (!LHSComplexFloat && !lhs->isRealFloatingType()) {
415 if (!isCompAssign) {
416 // int -> float -> _Complex float
417 if (lhs->isIntegerType()) {
418 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(rhs)->getElementType();
419 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, fp, CK_IntegralToFloating);
420 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
421 } else {
422 assert(lhs->isComplexIntegerType());
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000423 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000424 }
425 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000426 return rhs;
427 }
428
429 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
430 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
431 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
432 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
433 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
434 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
435 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
436 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
437 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
438 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
439 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
440
441 // If both are complex, just cast to the more precise type.
442 if (LHSComplexFloat && RHSComplexFloat) {
443 if (order > 0) {
444 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000445 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000446 return lhs;
447
448 } else if (order < 0) {
449 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
450 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000451 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000452 return rhs;
453 }
454 return lhs;
455 }
456
457 // If just the LHS is complex, the RHS needs to be converted,
458 // and the LHS might need to be promoted.
459 if (LHSComplexFloat) {
460 if (order > 0) { // LHS is wider
461 // float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000462 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(lhs)->getElementType();
463 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, fp, CK_FloatingCast);
464 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000465 return lhs;
466 }
467
468 // RHS is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type.
469 QualType result = (order == 0 ? lhs : Context.getComplexType(rhs));
470
471 // double -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000472 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000473
474 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
475 if (!isCompAssign && order < 0)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000476 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000477
478 return result;
479 }
480
481 // Just the RHS is complex, so the LHS needs to be converted
482 // and the RHS might need to be promoted.
483 assert(RHSComplexFloat);
484
485 if (order < 0) { // RHS is wider
486 // float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000487 if (!isCompAssign) {
488 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingCast);
489 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
490 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000491 return rhs;
492 }
493
494 // LHS is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type.
495 QualType result = (order == 0 ? rhs : Context.getComplexType(lhs));
496
497 // double -> _Complex double
498 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000499 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000500
501 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
502 if (order > 0)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000503 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000504
505 return result;
506 }
507
508 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
509 bool LHSFloat = lhs->isRealFloatingType();
510 bool RHSFloat = rhs->isRealFloatingType();
511 if (LHSFloat || RHSFloat) {
512 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
513 // to the bigger result.
514 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
515 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
516 if (order > 0) {
517 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingCast);
518 return lhs;
519 }
520
521 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
522 if (!isCompAssign)
523 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingCast);
524 return rhs;
525 }
526
527 // If we have an integer operand, the result is the real floating type.
528 if (LHSFloat) {
529 if (rhs->isIntegerType()) {
530 // Convert rhs to the lhs floating point type.
531 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralToFloating);
532 return lhs;
533 }
534
535 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
536 assert(rhs->isComplexIntegerType());
537 QualType result = Context.getComplexType(lhs);
538
539 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000540 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000541
542 // float -> _Complex float
543 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000544 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000545
546 return result;
547 }
548
549 assert(RHSFloat);
550 if (lhs->isIntegerType()) {
551 // Convert lhs to the rhs floating point type.
552 if (!isCompAssign)
553 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralToFloating);
554 return rhs;
555 }
556
557 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
558 assert(lhs->isComplexIntegerType());
559 QualType result = Context.getComplexType(rhs);
560
561 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
562 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000563 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000564
565 // float -> _Complex float
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000566 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000567
568 return result;
569 }
570
571 // Handle GCC complex int extension.
572 // FIXME: if the operands are (int, _Complex long), we currently
573 // don't promote the complex. Also, signedness?
574 const ComplexType *lhsComplexInt = lhs->getAsComplexIntegerType();
575 const ComplexType *rhsComplexInt = rhs->getAsComplexIntegerType();
576 if (lhsComplexInt && rhsComplexInt) {
577 int order = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(lhsComplexInt->getElementType(),
578 rhsComplexInt->getElementType());
579 assert(order && "inequal types with equal element ordering");
580 if (order > 0) {
581 // _Complex int -> _Complex long
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000582 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000583 return lhs;
584 }
585
586 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000587 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000588 return rhs;
589 } else if (lhsComplexInt) {
590 // int -> _Complex int
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000591 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000592 return lhs;
593 } else if (rhsComplexInt) {
594 // int -> _Complex int
595 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000596 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000597 return rhs;
598 }
599
600 // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
601 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
602 int compare = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
603 bool lhsSigned = lhs->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(),
604 rhsSigned = rhs->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
605 if (lhsSigned == rhsSigned) {
606 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
607 if (compare >= 0) {
608 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
609 return lhs;
610 } else if (!isCompAssign)
611 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
612 return rhs;
613 } else if (compare != (lhsSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
614 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
615 // signed type, so use the unsigned type
616 if (rhsSigned) {
617 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
618 return lhs;
619 } else if (!isCompAssign)
620 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
621 return rhs;
622 } else if (Context.getIntWidth(lhs) != Context.getIntWidth(rhs)) {
623 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
624 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
625 // use the signed type.
626 if (lhsSigned) {
627 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
628 return lhs;
629 } else if (!isCompAssign)
630 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
631 return rhs;
632 } else {
633 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
634 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
635 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding
636 // to the signed type.
637 QualType result =
638 Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhsSigned ? lhs : rhs);
639 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralCast);
640 if (!isCompAssign)
641 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralCast);
642 return result;
643 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000644}
645
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000646//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
647// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
648//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
649
650
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000651/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000652/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
653/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
654/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
655/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000656///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000657ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000658Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000659 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
660
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000661 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000662 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000663 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000664
665 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
666 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
667 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000668
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000669 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000670 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000671 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000672
673 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000674 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000675 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000676
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000677 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
678 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
679 // strings.
680 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000681 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000682 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000683
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000684 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000685 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
686 Literal.GetStringLength(),
687 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
688 &StringTokLocs[0],
689 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000690}
691
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000692/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
693/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
694/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
695/// for values inside the block or for globals).
696///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000697/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000698/// up-to-date.
699///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000700static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000701 ValueDecl *VD) {
702 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
703 // we wanted to.
704 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
705 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000706
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000707 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
708 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
709 return false;
710
711 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
712 // snapshot it.
713 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
714 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000715 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
716 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000717
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000718 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
719 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
720
721 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
722 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
723 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
724 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000725 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
726 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000727
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000728 if (!NextBlock)
729 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000730
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000731 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
732 // having a reference outside it.
733 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
734 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000735
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000736 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
737 // a snapshot as well.
738 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
739 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000740
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000741 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000742}
743
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000744
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000745ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000746Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000747 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000748 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
749 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
750}
751
752/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000753ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000754Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
755 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
756 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000757 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000758 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000759 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000760 << D->getDeclName();
761 return ExprError();
762 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000763
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000764 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000765 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
766 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
767 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000768 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000769 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000770 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
771 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000772 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
773 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000774 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000775 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000776 << D->getIdentifier();
777 return ExprError();
778 }
779 }
780 }
781 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000782
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000783 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000784
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000785 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
786 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
787 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000788 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000789}
790
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000791/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
792/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
793/// actual member.
794///
795/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
796/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
797/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
798/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
799/// we found.
800///
801/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
802/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
803/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
804VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
805 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000806 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
807 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
808 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
809
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000810 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000811 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
812 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
813 do {
814 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000815 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000816 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000817 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000818 else {
819 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
820 break;
821 }
822 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000823 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000824 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000825
826 return BaseObject;
827}
828
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000829ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000830Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
831 FieldDecl *Field,
832 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
833 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
834 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000835 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000836 AnonFields);
837
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000838 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
839 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
840 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
841 // found via name lookup.
842 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000843 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000844 if (BaseObject) {
845 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
846 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000847 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000848 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patela2c21a22010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000849 Loc);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000850 BaseQuals
851 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000852 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
853 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
854 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
855 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
856 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000857 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000858 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
859 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
860 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000861 BaseQuals
862 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000863 } else {
864 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
865 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
866 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000867 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
868 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000869 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000870 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000871 = Context.getTagDeclType(
872 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
873 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000874 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000875 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
876 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
877 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000878 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000879 MD->getThisType(Context),
880 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000881 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
882 }
883 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000884 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
885 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000886 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000887 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000888 }
889
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000890 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000891 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
892 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000893 }
894
895 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
896 // anonymous struct/union.
897 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000898 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000899 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
900 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
901 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
902 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000903 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
904 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
905
906 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
907 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
908 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
909 ResultQuals.removeConst();
910
911 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
912 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
913
914 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
915 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
916
917 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
918 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
919 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
920
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000921 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000922 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000923 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000924 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
925 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000926 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000927 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000928 }
929
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000930 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000931}
932
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000933/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000934/// possibly a list of template arguments.
935///
936/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
937/// DecomposeTemplateName.
938///
939/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
940/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
941/// some way.
942static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
943 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
944 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000945 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000946 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
947 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
948 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
949 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
950
951 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
952 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
953 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
954 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
955 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
956
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000957 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000958 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
959 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000960 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
961 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000962 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000963 TemplateArgs = 0;
964 }
965}
966
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000967/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
968/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
969/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000970static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000971 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
972 return false;
973
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000974 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
975 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
976 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
977 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
978 if (!BaseRT) return false;
979
980 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000981 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000982 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
983 return false;
984 }
985
986 return true;
987}
988
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000989/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
990/// the prospective base classes.
991static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
992 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
993 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000994 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000995 return false;
996
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000997 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000998 if (!RD) return false;
999 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
1000
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001001 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
1002 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
1003 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
1004 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
1005 if (!BaseRT) return false;
1006
1007 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001008 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
1009 return false;
1010 }
1011
1012 return true;
1013}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001014
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001015enum IMAKind {
1016 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
1017 IMA_Static,
1018
1019 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
1020 IMA_Mixed,
1021
1022 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
1023 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
1024 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
1025
1026 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
1027 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
1028 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
1029
1030 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
1031 IMA_Instance,
1032
1033 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
1034 IMA_Unresolved,
1035
1036 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
1037 /// context is not an instance method.
1038 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
1039
1040 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
1041 /// non-class context.
1042 IMA_AnonymousMember,
1043
1044 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
1045 /// context is not an instance method.
1046 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
1047
1048 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
1049 /// class.
1050 IMA_Error_Unrelated
1051};
1052
1053/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
1054/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
1055/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
1056/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
1057/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
1058/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
1059static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
1060 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001061 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001062
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001063 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001064 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001065 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
1066 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001067
1068 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1069 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
1070
1071 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
1072 bool hasNonInstance = false;
1073 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
1074 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001075 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1076 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001077 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
1078
1079 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
1080 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
1081 // that's a special case.
1082 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
1083 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
1084 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
1085 }
1086 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
1087 }
1088 else
1089 hasNonInstance = true;
1090 }
1091
1092 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
1093 // member reference.
1094 if (Classes.empty())
1095 return IMA_Static;
1096
1097 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
1098 // an implicit member reference.
1099 if (isStaticContext)
1100 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
1101
1102 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
1103 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
1104 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
1105 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001106 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001107 Classes))
1108 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
1109
1110 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
1111}
1112
1113/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
1114static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
1115 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1116 const LookupResult &R) {
1117 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1118 SourceRange Range(Loc);
1119 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
1120
1121 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
1122 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
1123 if (MD->isStatic()) {
1124 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
1125 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
1126 << Range << R.getLookupName();
1127 return;
1128 }
1129 }
1130
1131 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
1132 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
1133 return;
1134 }
1135
1136 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001137}
1138
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001139/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
1140///
1141/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001142bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
1143 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001144 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
1145
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001146 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001147 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001148 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
1149 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001150 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001151 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001152 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
1153 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001154
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001155 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
1156 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
1157 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
1158 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001159 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001160 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001161 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
1162 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1163
1164 if (!R.empty()) {
1165 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
1166 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1167
1168 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
1169 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
1170 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
1171 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
1172
1173 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
1174 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
1175 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001176 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001177 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
1178 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001179 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001180 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001181 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001182 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
1183 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
1184 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
1185 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
1186 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
1187 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
1188 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
1189 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
1190 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
1191 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
1192 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
1193 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
1194 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
1195 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001196 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001197 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
1198 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
1199 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001200 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001201 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001202 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001203 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001204
1205 // Do we really want to note all of these?
1206 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
1207 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
1208
1209 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1210 return false;
1211 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +00001212
1213 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001214 }
1215 }
1216
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001217 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001218 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +00001219 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001220 if (!R.empty()) {
1221 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
1222 if (SS.isEmpty())
1223 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
1224 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
1225 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
1226 else
1227 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1228 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1229 << SS.getRange()
1230 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
1231 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
1232 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
1233 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
1234 << ND->getDeclName();
1235
1236 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1237 return false;
1238 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001239
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001240 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
1241 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
1242 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
1243 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
1244 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
1245 // to recover well anyway.
1246 if (SS.isEmpty())
1247 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
1248 else
1249 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1250 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1251 << SS.getRange();
1252
1253 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1254 return true;
1255 }
1256 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001257 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001258 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001259 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001260 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001261 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001262 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001263 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1264 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001265 return true;
1266 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001267 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001268 }
1269
1270 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1271 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1272 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1273 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1274 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1275 << SS.getRange();
1276 return true;
1277 }
1278
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001279 // Give up, we can't recover.
1280 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1281 return true;
1282}
1283
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001284ObjCPropertyDecl *Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(IdentifierInfo *II) {
1285 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001286 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1287 if (!IDecl)
1288 return 0;
1289 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1290 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1291 return 0;
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001292 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001293 if (!property)
1294 return 0;
1295 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001296 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1297 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001298 return 0;
1299 return property;
1300}
1301
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001302bool Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(ObjCPropertyDecl *Property) {
1303 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
1304 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1305 if (!IDecl)
1306 return false;
1307 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1308 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1309 return false;
1310 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl
1311 = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(Property->getIdentifier()))
1312 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1313 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1314 return false;
1315
1316 return true;
1317}
1318
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001319static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001320 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001321 IdentifierInfo *II,
1322 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1323 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001324 bool LookForIvars;
1325 if (Lookup.empty())
1326 LookForIvars = true;
1327 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1328 LookForIvars = false;
1329 else
1330 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1331 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1332 if (!LookForIvars)
1333 return 0;
1334
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001335 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1336 if (!IDecl)
1337 return 0;
1338 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001339 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1340 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001341 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1342 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1343 if (!property)
1344 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001345 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001346 DynamicImplSeen =
1347 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001348 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1349 // one.
1350 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1351 return 0;
1352 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001353 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001354 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1355 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001356 NameLoc,
1357 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1358 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1359 (Expr *)0, true);
1360 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1361 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1362 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1363 return Ivar;
1364 }
1365 return 0;
1366}
1367
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001368ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001369 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1370 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1371 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1372 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001373 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1374 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1375
1376 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001377 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001378
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001379 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001380
1381 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001382 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001383 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001384 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001385
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001386 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001387 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001388 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001389
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001390 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1391 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001392 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1393 // (note: handled after lookup)
1394 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1395 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1396 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001397 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1398 // names a dependent type.
1399 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1400 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001401 bool DependentID = false;
1402 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1403 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1404 DependentID = true;
1405 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1406 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1407 if (DC) {
1408 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1409 return ExprError();
1410 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1411 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1412 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1413 } else {
1414 DependentID = true;
1415 }
1416 }
1417
1418 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001419 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001420 TemplateArgs);
1421 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001422 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001423 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001424 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001425 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001426 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1427 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1428 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1429 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1430 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001431 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1432 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1433 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001434 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001435 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001436 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001437
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001438 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1439 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001440 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001441 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001442 if (E.isInvalid())
1443 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001444
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001445 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1446 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001447 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1448 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahaniande267602010-11-17 19:41:23 +00001449 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc)) {
1450 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1451 canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II)) {
1452 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_synthesized_ivar_access) << II;
1453 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
1454 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001455 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1456 isAddressOfOperand);
Fariborz Jahaniande267602010-11-17 19:41:23 +00001457 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001458 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001459 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1460 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001461 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001462 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001463
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001464 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1465 return ExprError();
1466
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001467 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1468 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001469 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001470
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001471 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001472 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001473 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1474 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1475 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1476 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1477 }
1478
1479 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1480 // call, diagnose the problem.
1481 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001482 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001483 return ExprError();
1484
1485 assert(!R.empty() &&
1486 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001487
1488 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1489 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001490 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001491 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1492 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001493 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001494 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1495 return move(E);
1496 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001497 }
1498 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001499
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001500 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1501 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1502
1503 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001504 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001505 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1506 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001507 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001508 if (Property) {
1509 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1510 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001511 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001512 }
1513 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001514 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001515 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1516 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1517 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1518 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1519 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1520 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001521 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001522 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001523
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001524 QualType T = Func->getType();
1525 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001526 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001527 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1528 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001529 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001530 }
1531 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001532
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001533 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001534 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1535 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1536 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1537 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1538 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1539 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1540 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1541 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001542 //
1543 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1544 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1545 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1546 // non-static member function:
1547 //
1548 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1549 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1550 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1551 // member function call.
1552 //
1553 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1554 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1555 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1556 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001557 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001558 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1559 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1560 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1561 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1562 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1563 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1564 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001565 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1566 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001567 else
1568 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1569
1570 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001571 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001572 }
1573
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001574 if (TemplateArgs)
1575 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001576
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001577 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1578}
1579
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001580/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001581ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001582Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1583 LookupResult &R,
1584 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1585 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1586 case IMA_Instance:
1587 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1588
1589 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1590 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1591 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1592 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1593
1594 case IMA_Mixed:
1595 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1596 case IMA_Unresolved:
1597 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1598
1599 case IMA_Static:
1600 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1601 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1602 if (TemplateArgs)
1603 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1604 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1605
1606 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1607 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1608 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1609 return ExprError();
1610 }
1611
1612 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1613 return ExprError();
1614}
1615
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001616/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1617/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1618/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1619/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001620ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001621Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001622 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001623 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001624 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001625 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001626
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001627 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001628 return ExprError();
1629
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001630 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001631 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1632
1633 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1634 return ExprError();
1635
1636 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001637 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1638 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001639 return ExprError();
1640 }
1641
1642 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1643}
1644
1645/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1646/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1647/// additional lookup.
1648///
1649/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1650/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1651///
1652/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001653ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001654Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001655 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001656 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001657 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001658
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001659 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1660 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1661 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1662 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1663 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1664
1665 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1666 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1667 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001668 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001669
1670 bool LookForIvars;
1671 if (Lookup.empty())
1672 LookForIvars = true;
1673 else if (IsClassMethod)
1674 LookForIvars = false;
1675 else
1676 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1677 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001678 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001679 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001680 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001681 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1682 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1683 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1684 if (IsClassMethod)
1685 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1686 << IV->getDeclName());
1687
1688 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1689 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1690 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1691 return ExprError();
1692
1693 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1694 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1695 return ExprError();
1696
1697 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1698 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1699 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1700 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1701
1702 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1703 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1704 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1705 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001706 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001707 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001708 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001709 SelfName, false, false);
1710 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1711 return ExprError();
1712
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001713 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1714 return Owned(new (Context)
1715 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1716 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1717 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001718 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001719 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001720 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001721 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1722 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1723 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1724 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1725 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1726 }
1727 }
1728
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001729 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1730 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1731 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1732 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1733 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1734 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1735 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1736 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1737 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1738 }
1739 }
1740 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001741 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1742 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001743}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001744
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001745/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1746///
1747/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1748///
1749/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1750/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1751/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1752/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1753///
1754/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1755/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1756/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1757/// the class declaring the member.
1758///
1759/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1760/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1761/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001762bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001763Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1764 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001765 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001766 NamedDecl *Member) {
1767 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1768 if (!RD)
1769 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001770
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001771 QualType DestRecordType;
1772 QualType DestType;
1773 QualType FromRecordType;
1774 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1775 bool PointerConversions = false;
1776 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1777 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001778
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001779 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1780 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1781 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1782 PointerConversions = true;
1783 } else {
1784 DestType = DestRecordType;
1785 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001786 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001787 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1788 if (Method->isStatic())
1789 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001790
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001791 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1792 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001793
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001794 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1795 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1796 PointerConversions = true;
1797 } else {
1798 FromRecordType = FromType;
1799 DestType = DestRecordType;
1800 }
1801 } else {
1802 // No conversion necessary.
1803 return false;
1804 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001805
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001806 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1807 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001808
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001809 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1810 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1811 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001812
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001813 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1814 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1815
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001816 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001817
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001818 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001819 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001820 // class name.
1821 //
1822 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1823 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1824 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1825 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1826 //
1827 // class Base { public: int x; };
1828 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1829 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1830 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1831 //
1832 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1833 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1834 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1835 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001836 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001837 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1838 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1839 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1840
1841 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1842
1843 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1844 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1845 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1846 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001847 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001848 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001849 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001850 return true;
1851
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001852 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001853 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001854 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1855 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001856
1857 FromType = QType;
1858 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1859
1860 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1861 // we're done.
1862 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1863 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001864 }
1865 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001866
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001867 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001868
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001869 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1870 // down to the using declaration's type.
1871 //
1872 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1873 // class ever has member declarations.
1874 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1875 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1876 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1877 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1878
1879 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1880 // conversion is non-trivial.
1881 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1882 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001883 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001884 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001885 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001886 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001887
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001888 QualType UType = URecordType;
1889 if (PointerConversions)
1890 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001891 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001892 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001893 FromType = UType;
1894 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1895 }
1896
1897 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1898 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1899 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001900 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001901
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001902 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001903 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1904 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001905 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001906 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001907
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001908 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001909 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001910 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001911}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001912
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001913/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001914static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001915 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001916 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001917 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1918 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001919 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1920 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1921 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001922 if (SS.isSet()) {
1923 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1924 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001925 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001926
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001927 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001928 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1929 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001930}
1931
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001932/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1933/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1934/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1935/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001936ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001937Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1938 LookupResult &R,
1939 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1940 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001941 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1942
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001943 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001944
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001945 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1946 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001947 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001948 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001949 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001950 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001951 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001952
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001953 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1954 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001955 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1956 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001957 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1958 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001959 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1960 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1961 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1962 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001963 }
1964
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001965 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001966 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1967 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001968 SS,
1969 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1970 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001971}
1972
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001973bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001974 const LookupResult &R,
1975 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001976 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1977 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1978 return false;
1979
1980 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001981 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001982 return false;
1983
1984 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001985 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001986 return false;
1987
1988 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1989 // normal lookup:
1990 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1991 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1992
1993 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1994 // -- a declaration of a class member
1995 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1996 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001997 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001998 return false;
1999
2000 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2001 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
2002 // using-declaration
2003 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
2004 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
2005 // turn off ADL anyway).
2006 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2007 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2008 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
2009 return false;
2010
2011 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2012 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
2013 // template
2014 // And also for builtin functions.
2015 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2016 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
2017
2018 // But also builtin functions.
2019 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
2020 return false;
2021 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
2022 return false;
2023 }
2024
2025 return true;
2026}
2027
2028
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002029/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
2030/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
2031/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
2032/// will in fact be used.
2033static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
2034 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
2035 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
2036 return true;
2037 }
2038
2039 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
2040 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
2041 return true;
2042 }
2043
2044 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
2045 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
2046 return true;
2047 }
2048
2049 return false;
2050}
2051
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002052ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002053Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002054 LookupResult &R,
2055 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00002056 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
2057 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00002058 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002059 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
2060 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002061
2062 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
2063 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
2064 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002065 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
2066 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002067 return ExprError();
2068
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002069 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
2070 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
2071 // we've picked a target.
2072 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2073
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002074 bool Dependent
2075 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002076 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002077 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002078 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002079 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002080 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
2081 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002082
2083 return Owned(ULE);
2084}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002085
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002086
2087/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002088ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002089Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002090 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2091 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002092 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00002093 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
2094 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002095
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002096 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002097 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
2098 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002099
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002100 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
2101 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
2102 // a template argument list.
2103 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
2104 << Template << SS.getRange();
2105 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
2106 return ExprError();
2107 }
2108
2109 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
2110 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
2111 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002112 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002113 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00002114 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002115 return ExprError();
2116 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002117
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002118 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
2119 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
2120 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
2121 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002122 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002123 return ExprError();
2124
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002125 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
2126 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002127 return ExprError();
2128
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002129 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
2130 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
2131 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
2132 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002133 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002134 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
2135 // as they do not get snapshotted.
2136 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002137 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00002138 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00002139 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
2140 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
2141 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2142 return ExprError();
2143 }
2144
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00002145 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00002146 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
2147 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2148 return ExprError();
2149 }
2150
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00002151 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00002152 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00002153 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Fariborz Jahaniane2204552010-11-16 19:29:39 +00002154 bool byrefVar = (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>() != 0);
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00002155 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane2204552010-11-16 19:29:39 +00002156 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE;
2157
2158 if (!byrefVar) {
2159 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
2160 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
2161 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
2162 ExprTy.addConst();
2163 BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
2164 constAdded);
2165 }
2166 else
2167 BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true);
2168
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002169 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2170 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
2171 Expr *E = new (Context)
2172 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
2173 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00002174 if (T->getAs<RecordType>())
2175 if (!T->isUnionType()) {
2176 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002177 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00002178 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002179 SourceLocation(),
2180 Owned(E));
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00002181 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
2182 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
2183 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
2184 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
2185 }
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002186 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00002187 }
2188 }
2189 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00002190 }
2191 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
2192 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002193
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002194 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
2195 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002196}
2197
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002198ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002199 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002200 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002201
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002202 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00002203 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002204 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
2205 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
2206 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002207 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00002208
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00002209 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
2210 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002211
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002212 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00002213 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
2214 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002215 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002216 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002217 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002218 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002219
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002220 QualType ResTy;
2221 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
2222 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
2223 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00002224 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002225
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002226 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002227 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002228 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
2229 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002230 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002231}
2232
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002233ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002234 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002235 bool Invalid = false;
2236 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
2237 if (Invalid)
2238 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002239
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00002240 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
2241 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002242 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002243 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002244
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002245 QualType Ty;
2246 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
2247 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
2248 else if (Literal.isWide())
2249 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00002250 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
2251 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002252 else
2253 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002254
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002255 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
2256 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002257 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002258}
2259
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002260ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002261 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002262 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
2263 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00002264 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00002265 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002266 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00002267 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002268 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00002269
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002270 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00002271 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
2272 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002273 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002274
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002275 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002276 bool Invalid = false;
2277 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
2278 if (Invalid)
2279 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002280
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002281 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002282 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
2283 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002284 return ExprError();
2285
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002286 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002287
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002288 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002289 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002290 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002291 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002292 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002293 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002294 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002295 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002296
2297 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2298
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002299 using llvm::APFloat;
2300 APFloat Val(Format);
2301
2302 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002303
2304 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2305 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2306 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2307 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002308 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002309 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002310 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002311 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002312 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2313 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002314 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002315 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2316 }
2317
2318 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2319 << Ty
2320 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2321 }
2322
2323 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002324 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002325
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002326 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002327 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002328 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002329 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002330
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002331 // long long is a C99 feature.
2332 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002333 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002334 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2335
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002336 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002337 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002338
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002339 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2340 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2341 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002342 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2343 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002344 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002345 } else {
2346 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2347 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002348
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002349 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2350 // be an unsigned int.
2351 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2352
2353 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002354 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002355 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2356 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002357 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002358
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002359 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2360 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2361 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2362 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002363 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002364 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002365 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002366 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002367 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002368 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002369
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002370 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002371 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002372 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002373
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002374 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2375 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2376 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2377 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002378 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002379 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002380 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002381 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002382 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002383 }
2384
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002385 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002386 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002387 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002388
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002389 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2390 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2391 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2392 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002393 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002394 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002395 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002396 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002397 }
2398 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002399
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002400 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2401 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002402 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002403 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002404 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002405 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002406 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002407
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002408 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2409 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002410 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002411 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002412 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002413
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002414 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2415 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002416 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002417 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002418
2419 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002420}
2421
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002422ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002423 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002424 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002425 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002426}
2427
2428/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2429/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002430bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002431 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002432 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002433 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002434 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2435 return false;
2436
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002437 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2438 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2439 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2440 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2441 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2442 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2443
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002444 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002445 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002446 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002447 if (isSizeof)
2448 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2449 return false;
2450 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002451
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002452 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002453 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002454 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2455 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002456 return false;
2457 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002458
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002459 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002460 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2461 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002462 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002463
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002464 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002465 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002466 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002467 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2468 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002469 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002470
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002471 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002472}
2473
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002474static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2475 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002476 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002477
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002478 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002479 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2480 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002481
2482 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2483 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2484 return false;
2485
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002486 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002487 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002488 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002489 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002490
2491 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2492 // bit-field.
2493 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002494 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002495 return false;
2496
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002497 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002498}
2499
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002500/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002501ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002502Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002503 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002504 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002505 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002506 return ExprError();
2507
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002508 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002509
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002510 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2511 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2512 return ExprError();
2513
2514 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002515 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002516 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2517 R.getEnd()));
2518}
2519
2520/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2521/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002522ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002523Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002524 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2525 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2526 bool isInvalid = false;
2527 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2528 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2529 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002530 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002531 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002532 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2533 isInvalid = true;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002534 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2535 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2536 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2537 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002538 } else {
2539 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2540 }
2541
2542 if (isInvalid)
2543 return ExprError();
2544
2545 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2546 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2547 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2548 R.getEnd()));
2549}
2550
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002551/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2552/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2553/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002554ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002555Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2556 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002557 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002558 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002559
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002560 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002561 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002562 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002563 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002564 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002565
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002566 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002567 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002568 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2569
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002570 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002571}
2572
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002573QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002574 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2575 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002576
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002577 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002578 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002579 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002580
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002581 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2582 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2583 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002584
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002585 // Test for placeholders.
2586 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2587 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2588 if (PR.take() != V) {
2589 V = PR.take();
2590 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2591 }
2592
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002593 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002594 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2595 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002596 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002597}
2598
2599
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002600
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002601ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002602Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002603 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002604 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002605 switch (Kind) {
2606 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002607 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2608 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002609 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002610
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002611 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002612}
2613
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002614ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002615Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2616 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002617 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002618 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002619 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2620 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002621
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002622 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002623
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002624 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002625 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002626 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2627 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2628 }
2629
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002630 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002631 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002632 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2633 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2634 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002635 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002636 }
2637
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002638 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002639}
2640
2641
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002642ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002643Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2644 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2645 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2646 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002647
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002648 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002649 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2650 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2651 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002652
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002653 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002654
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002655 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002656 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002657 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002658 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002659 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2660 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002661 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2662 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2663 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2664 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002665 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002666 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2667 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002668 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002669 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002670 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002671 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2672 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002673 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002674 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002675 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002676 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2677 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2678 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002679 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002680 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002681 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2682 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2683 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2684 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002685 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002686 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002687 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002688
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002689 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2690 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002691 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2692 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002693 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002694 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2695 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2696 // force the promotion here.
2697 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2698 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002699 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002700 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002701 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2702
2703 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2704 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002705 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002706 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2707 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2708 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2709 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002710 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002711 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002712 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2713
2714 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2715 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002716 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002717 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002718 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2719 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002720 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002721 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002722 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002723 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2724 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002725
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002726 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002727 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2728 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002729 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2730
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002731 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002732 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2733 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002734 // incomplete types are not object types.
2735 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2736 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2737 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2738 return ExprError();
2739 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002740
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002741 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2742 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2743 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2744 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2745 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002746 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002747 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2748 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002749 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002750
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002751 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002752 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002753 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2754 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2755 return ExprError();
2756 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002757
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002758 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002759 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002760}
2761
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002762QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002763CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002764 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002765 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002766 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2767 // see FIXME there.
2768 //
2769 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2770 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002771 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002772
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002773 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002774 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002775
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002776 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002777 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2778 // to be selected.
2779 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002780
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002781 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2782 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002783 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002784
2785 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2786 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002787 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002788 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2789 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002790 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002791 do
2792 compStr++;
2793 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002794 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002795 do
2796 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002797 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002798 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002799
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002800 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002801 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2802 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002803 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002804 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002805 return QualType();
2806 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002807
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002808 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2809 // operates on.
2810 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002811 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002812
2813 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002814 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002815
2816 while (*compStr) {
2817 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2818 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2819 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2820 return QualType();
2821 }
2822 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002823 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002824
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002825 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002826 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002827 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002828 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002829 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002830 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002831 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002832 if (HexSwizzle)
2833 CompSize--;
2834
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002835 if (CompSize == 1)
2836 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002837
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002838 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002839 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002840 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2841 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2842 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2843 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002844 }
2845 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002846}
2847
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002848static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002849 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002850 const Selector &Sel,
2851 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002852 if (Member)
2853 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2854 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002855 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002856 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002857
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002858 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2859 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002860 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2861 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002862 return D;
2863 }
2864 return 0;
2865}
2866
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002867static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2868 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2869 const Selector &Sel,
2870 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002871 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2872 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002873 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002874 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002875 if (Member)
2876 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2877 GDecl = PD;
2878 break;
2879 }
2880 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002881 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002882 GDecl = OMD;
2883 break;
2884 }
2885 }
2886 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002887 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002888 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2889 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002890 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2891 Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002892 if (GDecl)
2893 return GDecl;
2894 }
2895 }
2896 return GDecl;
2897}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002898
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002899ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002900Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002901 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002902 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2903 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002904 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002905 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002906 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2907 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2908 //
2909 // T* t;
2910 // t.f;
2911 //
2912 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2913 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2914 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2915 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002916 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002917 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2918 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002919 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002920 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002921 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002922 return ExprError();
2923 }
2924 }
2925
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002926 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2927 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002928 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002929
2930 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2931 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002932 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002933 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002934 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002935 SS.getRange(),
2936 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002937 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002938}
2939
2940/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2941/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2942/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2943static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2944 Expr *BaseExpr,
2945 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002946 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002947 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002948 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2949 // diagnostics.
2950 if (!BaseExpr)
2951 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002952
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002953 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2954 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002955}
2956
2957// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2958// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2959// type. The restriction here is:
2960//
2961// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2962// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2963// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2964//
2965// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2966// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2967// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2968// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2969bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2970 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002971 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002972 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002973 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2974 if (!BaseRT) {
2975 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2976 // dependent.
2977 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2978 return false;
2979 }
2980 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981
2982 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002983 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2984 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002985 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002986 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002987
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002988 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002989 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2990 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2991 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002992
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002993 if (!DC->isRecord())
2994 continue;
2995
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002996 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002997 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002998
2999 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
3000 return false;
3001 }
3002
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003003 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003004 return true;
3005}
3006
3007static bool
3008LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
3009 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003010 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3011 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003012 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
3013 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00003014 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003015 << BaseRange))
3016 return true;
3017
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003018 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
3019 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
3020 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
3021
3022 bool MOUS;
3023 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
3024 return false;
3025 }
3026
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003027 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
3028 if (SS.isSet()) {
3029 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
3030 // nested-name-specifier.
3031 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
3032
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00003033 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003034 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
3035 << SS.getRange() << DC;
3036 return true;
3037 }
3038
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003039 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003040
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003041 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
3042 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
3043 << DC << SS.getRange();
3044 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003045 }
3046 }
3047
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003048 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
3049 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003050
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003051 if (!R.empty())
3052 return false;
3053
3054 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
3055 // for typos.
3056 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003057 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003058 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003059 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
3060 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
3061 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003062 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3063 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003064 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
3065 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3066 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003067 return false;
3068 } else {
3069 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003070 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003071 }
3072
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003073 return false;
3074}
3075
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003076ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003077Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003078 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003079 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003080 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003081 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003082 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003083 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
3084 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003085 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003086 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3087 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003088 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003089
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003090 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003091
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003092 // Implicit member accesses.
3093 if (!Base) {
3094 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
3095 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
3096 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
3097 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003098 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003099 return ExprError();
3100
3101 // Explicit member accesses.
3102 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003103 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003104 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003105 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003106
3107 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3108 Owned(Base);
3109 return ExprError();
3110 }
3111
3112 if (Result.get())
3113 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00003114
3115 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
3116 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003117 }
3118
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003119 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003120 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3121 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003122}
3123
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003124ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003125Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003126 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
3127 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003128 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003129 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00003130 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
3131 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003132 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003133 if (IsArrow) {
3134 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
3135 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
3136 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003137 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003138
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003139 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003140 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
3141 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
3142 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003143
3144 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00003145 return ExprError();
3146
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003147 if (R.empty()) {
3148 // Rederive where we looked up.
3149 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
3150 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
3151 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003152
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003153 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003154 << MemberName << DC
3155 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003156 return ExprError();
3157 }
3158
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003159 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
3160 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
3161 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
3162 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
3163 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
3164 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
3165 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
3166 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
3167 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
3168 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00003169 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003170 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003171 return ExprError();
3172
3173 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
3174 // result.
3175 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003176 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00003177 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003178 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00003179 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003180
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00003181 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
3182 // pick a member.
3183 R.suppressDiagnostics();
3184
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003185 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
3186 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
3187 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003188 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
3189 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003190 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003191 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00003192 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003193
3194 return Owned(MemExpr);
3195 }
3196
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003197 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003198 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003199 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
3200
3201 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
3202
3203 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3204 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3205 // error cases.
3206 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
3207 return ExprError();
3208
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003209 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
3210 if (!BaseExpr) {
3211 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003212 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003213 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003214
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00003215 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
3216 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
3217 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
3218 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003219 }
3220
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003221 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
3222 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3223 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
3224 // explicitly qualified.
3225 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
3226 ShouldCheckUse = false;
3227 }
3228
3229 // Check the use of this member.
3230 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
3231 Owned(BaseExpr);
3232 return ExprError();
3233 }
3234
3235 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3236 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
3237 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00003238 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
3239 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003240 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
3241 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
3242
3243 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
3244 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
3245 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
3246 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
3247 else {
3248 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
3249 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3250 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
3251
3252 Qualifiers MemberQuals
3253 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
3254
3255 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
3256 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
3257 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
3258 }
3259
3260 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003261 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003262 return ExprError();
3263 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003264 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3265 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003266 }
3267
3268 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3269 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
3270 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003271 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003272 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
3273 }
3274
3275 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3276 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3277 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003278 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003279 MemberFn->getType()));
3280 }
3281
3282 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3283 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3284 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003285 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3286 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003287 }
3288
3289 Owned(BaseExpr);
3290
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003291 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003292 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003293 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003294 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3295 else
3296 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3297 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003298
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003299 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3300 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003301 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003302 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003303}
3304
3305/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3306/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3307/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3308/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3309/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3310/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3311/// an ordinary member expression.
3312///
3313/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3314/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003315ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003316Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003317 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003318 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003319 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003320 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003321
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003322 // Perform default conversions.
3323 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003324
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003325 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003326 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3327
3328 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3329 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003330
3331 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003332 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003333 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3334 // call, and continue on.
3335 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3336 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3337 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3338 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3339 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003340 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3341 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003342 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3343 ->isRecordType()))) {
3344 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewycky3d6c45d2010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003345 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003346 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003347 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003348
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003349 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003350 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003351 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003352 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003353 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003354
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003355 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3356 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3357 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3358 }
3359 }
3360 }
3361
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003362 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3363 // use that.
3364 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003365 if (IsArrow) {
3366 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3367 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3368 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003369 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003370 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003371 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3372 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003373 }
3374 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003375 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3376 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3377 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3378 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003379 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003380 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003381 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003382
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003383 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3384 // use that.
3385 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3386 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3387 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3388 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3389 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003390 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003391 }
3392 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003393
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003394 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003395
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003396 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003397 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003398 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3399 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3400 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3401 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3402 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3403 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3404 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3405 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3406 // Check the use of this method.
3407 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3408 return ExprError();
3409 }
3410 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3411 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3412 Selector SetterSel =
3413 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3414 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3415 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3416 if (!Setter) {
3417 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3418 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003419 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003420 }
3421 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3422 if (!Setter)
3423 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003424
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003425 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3426 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003427
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003428 if (Getter || Setter) {
3429 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003430
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003431 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003432 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003433 else
3434 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3435 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3436 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003437 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003438 PType,
3439 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3440 }
3441 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3442 << MemberName << BaseType);
3443 }
3444 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003445
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003446 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3447 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3448 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003449 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003450 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003451
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003452 if (IsArrow) {
3453 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003454 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003455 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3456 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003457 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3458 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3459 // struct MyRecord foo;
3460 // foo->bar
3461 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3462 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3463 // by now.
3464 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3465 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003466 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003467 IsArrow = false;
3468 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003469 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3470 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3471 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003472 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003473 } else {
3474 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3475 // type *foo;
3476 // foo.bar
3477 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3478 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3479 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3480 // the appropriate pointer type
3481 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3482 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3483 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3484 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3485 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003486 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003487 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3488 IsArrow = true;
3489 }
3490 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003491 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003492
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003493 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003494 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003495 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003496 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003497 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003498 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003499 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003500
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003501 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3502 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003503 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003504 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003505 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003506 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3507 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3508 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3509 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003510 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3511
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003512 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003513 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003514
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003515 if (!IV) {
3516 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3517 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3518 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor9a632ea2010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003519 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3520 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3521 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003522 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003523 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003524 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3525 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003526 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3527 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003528 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003529 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003530 } else {
3531 Res.clear();
3532 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003533 }
3534 }
3535
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003536 if (IV) {
3537 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3538 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3539 // error cases.
3540 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3541 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003542
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003543 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3544 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3545 return ExprError();
3546 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3547 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3548 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3549 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3550 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3551 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3552 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3553 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3554 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3555 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3556 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3557 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003558 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003559 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003560 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3561 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003562 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003563 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3564 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003565
3566 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3567 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003568 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003569 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003570 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003571 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3572 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003573 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003574 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003575 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003576
3577 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3578 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003579 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003580 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003581 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003582 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003583 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003584 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003585 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003586 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003587 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3588 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003589 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003590 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003591
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003592 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003593 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003594 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3595 Context)) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003596 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3597 // Check the use of this declaration
3598 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3599 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003600
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003601 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003602 MemberLoc,
3603 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003604 }
3605 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3606 // Check the use of this method.
3607 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3608 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003609 Selector SetterSel =
3610 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3611 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3612 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3613 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3614 SetterSel, Context))
3615 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3616 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3617 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3618 SMD,
3619 MemberLoc,
3620 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003621 }
3622 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003623
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003624 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003625 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003626 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003627
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003628 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3629 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003630 if (!IsArrow)
3631 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3632 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003633 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3634 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003635
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003636 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003637 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003638 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3639 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003640 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003641 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003642 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003643
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003644 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003645 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003646 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003647 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3648 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003649 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003650 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003651 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003652 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003653
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003654 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3655 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3656
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003657 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003658}
3659
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003660/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3661/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3662/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3663/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3664/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3665///
3666/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3667/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3668/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3669/// only be called
3670/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3671/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3672/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003673ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003674 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3675 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003676 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003677 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003678 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003679 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3680 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3681 return ExprError();
3682
3683 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3684
3685 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003686 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003687 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3688 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003689 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003690
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003691 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003692 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3693
3694 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3695 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3696 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3697
3698 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003699 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003700 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3701 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003702
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003703 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3704 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003705 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003706 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3707 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003708 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003709 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003710 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003711 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3712 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003713
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003714 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3715 Owned(Base);
3716 return ExprError();
3717 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003718
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003719 if (Result.get()) {
3720 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3721 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3722 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3723 // call now.
3724 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3725 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003726 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003727
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003728 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003729 }
3730
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003731 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003732 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3733 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003734 }
3735
3736 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003737}
3738
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003739ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003740 FunctionDecl *FD,
3741 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3742 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003743 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003744 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3745 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003746 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003747 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003748 return ExprError();
3749 }
3750
3751 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3752 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003753
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003754 // Instantiate the expression.
3755 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3756 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003757
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003758 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3759 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3760 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3761 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003762
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003763 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3764 if (Result.isInvalid())
3765 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003766
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003767 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3768 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003769 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003770 InitializationKind Kind
3771 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3772 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3773 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003774
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003775 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3776 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3777 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3778 if (Result.isInvalid())
3779 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003780
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003781 // Build the default argument expression.
3782 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3783 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003784 }
3785
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003786 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3787 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3788 // be properly destroyed.
3789 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3790 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003791 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3792 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3793 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3794 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3795 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3796 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003797
3798 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003799 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3800 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003801 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003802 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003803}
3804
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003805/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3806/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3807/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3808/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3809/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3810/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003811bool
3812Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003813 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003814 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003815 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3816 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003817 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003818 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3819 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003820 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003821
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003822 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3823 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3824 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3825 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3826 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003827 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003828 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003829 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003830 }
3831
3832 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3833 // them.
3834 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3835 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3836 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3837 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003838 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003839 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003840 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3841 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3842 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003843 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003844 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003845 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003846 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003847 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003848 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003849 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3850 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3851 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3852 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3853 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003854 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003855 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003856 if (Invalid)
3857 return true;
3858 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3859 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3860 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003861
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003862 return false;
3863}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003864
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003865bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3866 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3867 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3868 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3869 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3870 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003871 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003872 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3873 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3874 bool Invalid = false;
3875 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3876 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3877 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3878 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003879 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003880 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003881 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003882
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003883 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003884 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3885 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003886
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003887 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3888 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003889 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003890 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003891 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003892
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003893 // Pass the argument
3894 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3895 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3896 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003897
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003898 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003899 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3900 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003901 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003902 SourceLocation(),
3903 Owned(Arg));
3904 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3905 return true;
3906
3907 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003908 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003909 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003910
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003911 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003912 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003913 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3914 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003915
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003916 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003917 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003918 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003919 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003920
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003921 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003922 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003923 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003924 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003925 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003926 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003927 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003928 }
3929 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003930 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003931}
3932
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003933/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003934/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3935/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003936ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003937Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003938 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003939 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003940
3941 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003942 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003943 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3944 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003945
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003946 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003947
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003948 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003949 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3950 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3951 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3952 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3953 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003954 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003955 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3956 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003957
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003958 NumArgs = 0;
3959 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003960
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003961 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3962 RParenLoc));
3963 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003964
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003965 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003966 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003967 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3968 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003969 bool Dependent = false;
3970 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3971 Dependent = true;
3972 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3973 Dependent = true;
3974
3975 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003976 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003977 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3978
3979 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3980 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3981 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003982 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003983
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003984 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3985
3986 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3987 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3988 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3989 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3990 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3991 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3992 // method template.
3993 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003994 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3995 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003996 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003997
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003998 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003999 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004000 }
4001
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00004002 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004003 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004004 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004005 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004006 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00004007 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004008 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004009
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004010 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004011 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004012 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
4013 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00004014 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
4015 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00004016 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004017
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004018 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
4019 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
4020 NumArgs, ResultTy,
4021 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004022
4023 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
4024 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004025 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004026 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00004027
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004028 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004029 RParenLoc))
4030 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004031
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004032 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004033 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004034 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004035 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4036 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004037 }
4038 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004039 }
4040
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00004041 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004042 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004043 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004044
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00004045 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregoref9b1492010-11-09 20:03:54 +00004046 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
4047 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
4048 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
4049 RParenLoc);
4050 }
4051
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004052 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregord8f0ade2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00004053 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
4054 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
4055 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
4056
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004057 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
4058 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
4059
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004060 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
4061}
4062
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004063/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
4064/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004065/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
4066/// block-pointer type.
4067///
4068/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004069ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004070Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
4071 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4072 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4073 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4074 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
4075
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00004076 // Promote the function operand.
4077 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
4078
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004079 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
4080 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004081 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
4082 Args, NumArgs,
4083 Context.BoolTy,
4084 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004085
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004086 const FunctionType *FuncT;
4087 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
4088 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
4089 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004090 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004091 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004092 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4093 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004094 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004095 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004096 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004097 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004098 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004099 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004100 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4101 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4102
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004103 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004104 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004105 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004106 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004107 return ExprError();
4108
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004109 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00004110 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004111
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004112 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004113 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004114 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004115 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004116 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004117 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004118
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00004119 if (FDecl) {
4120 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
4121 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
4122 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00004123 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004124 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
4125 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4126 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00004127 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
4128 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00004129 }
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004130
4131 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
4132 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
4133 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
4134 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00004135 }
4136
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00004137 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004138 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
4139 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004140
4141 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004142 InitializedEntity Entity
4143 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
4144 Proto->getArgType(i));
4145 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
4146 SourceLocation(),
4147 Owned(Arg));
4148 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4149 return true;
4150
4151 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
4152
4153 } else {
4154 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004155 }
4156
Douglas Gregor0700bbf2010-10-26 05:45:40 +00004157 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4158 Arg->getType(),
4159 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
4160 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
4161 return ExprError();
4162
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004163 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00004164 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004165 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004166
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004167 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
4168 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004169 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
4170 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004171
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00004172 // Check for sentinels
4173 if (NDecl)
4174 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004175
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00004176 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004177 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004178 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004179 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004180
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00004181 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004182 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004183 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004184 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004185 return ExprError();
4186 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00004187
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004188 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004189}
4190
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004191ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004192Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004193 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004194 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00004195 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004196 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004197
4198 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4199 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
4200 if (!TInfo)
4201 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
4202
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004203 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004204}
4205
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004206ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004207Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004208 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004209 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00004210
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00004211 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise6fe9a22010-11-08 19:14:19 +00004212 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
4213 PDiag(diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type)
4214 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
4215 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
4216 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004217 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004218 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
4219 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00004220 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
4221 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00004222 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004223 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00004224 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004225 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00004226
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004227 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00004228 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004229 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004230 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004231 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004232 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004233 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00004234 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004235 &literalType);
4236 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004237 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004238 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00004239
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00004240 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00004241 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00004242 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004243 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00004244 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004245
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004246 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004247 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004248}
4249
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004250ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004251Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004252 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
4253 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004254 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00004255
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00004256 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004257 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004258
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004259 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
4260 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00004261 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004262 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004263}
4264
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004265/// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
4266/// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
4267static CastKind PrepareScalarCast(Sema &S, Expr *&Src, QualType DestTy) {
4268 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
4269 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
4270 // pointers. Everything else should be possible.
4271
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004272 QualType SrcTy = Src->getType();
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004273 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004274 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004275
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004276 switch (SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4277 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4278 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
4279
4280 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4281 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4282 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4283 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004284 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
4285 CK_BitCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004286 case Type::STK_Bool:
4287 return CK_PointerToBoolean;
4288 case Type::STK_Integral:
4289 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
4290 case Type::STK_Floating:
4291 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
4292 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
4293 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4294 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer");
4295 }
4296 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004297
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004298 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
4299 case Type::STK_Integral:
4300 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4301 case Type::STK_Pointer:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004302 if (Src->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004303 return CK_NullToPointer;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004304 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004305 case Type::STK_Bool:
4306 return CK_IntegralToBoolean;
4307 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004308 return CK_IntegralCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004309 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004310 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004311 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004312 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004313 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004314 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4315 CK_IntegralToFloating);
4316 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004317 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4318 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004319 }
4320 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004321
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004322 case Type::STK_Floating:
4323 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4324 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004325 return CK_FloatingCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004326 case Type::STK_Bool:
4327 return CK_FloatingToBoolean;
4328 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004329 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004330 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004331 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004332 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004333 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4334 CK_FloatingToIntegral);
4335 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004336 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4337 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
4338 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4339 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004340 }
4341 break;
4342
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004343 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
4344 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4345 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004346 return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004347 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004348 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004349 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004350 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004351 case Type::STK_Bool:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004352 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004353 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004354 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType(),
4355 CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
4356 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004357 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4358 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
4359 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4360 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004361 }
4362 break;
4363
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004364 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
4365 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4366 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004367 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004368 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004369 return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004370 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004371 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004372 case Type::STK_Bool:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004373 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004374 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004375 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType(),
4376 CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
4377 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004378 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4379 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
4380 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4381 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004382 }
4383 break;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004384 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004385
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004386 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
4387 return CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004388}
4389
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004390/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00004391bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004392 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004393 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00004394 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004395 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor40749ee2010-11-03 00:35:38 +00004396 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(SourceRange(TyR.getBegin(),
4397 castExpr->getLocEnd()),
4398 castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004399 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004400
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004401 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004402
4403 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4404 // type needs to be scalar.
4405 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
4406 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004407 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004408 return false;
4409 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004410
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004411 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4412 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4413 return true;
4414
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004415 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004416 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004417 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4418 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004419 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004420 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4421 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004422 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004423 return false;
4424 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004425
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004426 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004427 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004428 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004429 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004430 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004431 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004432 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara8c4bfe52010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004433 castExpr->getType()) &&
4434 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004435 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4436 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4437 break;
4438 }
4439 }
4440 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4441 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4442 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004443 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004444 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004445 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004446
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004447 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4448 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4449 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4450 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004451
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004452 // The type we're casting to is known to be a scalar or vector.
4453
4454 // Require the operand to be a scalar or vector.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004455 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004456 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004457 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4458 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004459 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004460 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004461
4462 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004463 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004464
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004465 if (castType->isVectorType())
4466 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4467 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4468 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4469
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004470 // The source and target types are both scalars, i.e.
4471 // - arithmetic types (fundamental, enum, and complex)
4472 // - all kinds of pointers
4473 // Note that member pointers were filtered out with C++, above.
4474
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004475 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4476 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004477
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004478 // If either type is a pointer, the other type has to be either an
4479 // integer or a pointer.
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004480 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004481 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004482 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004483 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004484 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4485 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4486 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4487 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004488 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004489 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4490 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4491 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004492 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004493
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004494 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, castExpr, castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004495
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004496 if (Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004497 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4498
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004499 return false;
4500}
4501
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004502bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004503 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004504 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004505
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004506 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004507 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004508 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004509 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004510 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004511 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004512 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004513 } else
4514 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004515 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004516 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004517
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004518 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004519 return false;
4520}
4521
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004522bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004523 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004524 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004525
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004526 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004527
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004528 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4529 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004530 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4531 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4532 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4533 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004534 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004535 return false;
4536 }
4537
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004538 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004539 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4540 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004541 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4542 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4543 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4544 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004545
4546 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4547 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004548 PrepareScalarCast(*this, CastExpr, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004549
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004550 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004551 return false;
4552}
4553
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004554ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004555Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004556 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4557 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004558 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004559
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004560 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4561 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4562 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004563 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004564
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004565 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4566 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004567 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004568 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004569
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004570 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004571}
4572
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004573ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004574Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004575 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004576 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004577 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004578 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004579 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004580 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004581
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004582 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004583 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004584 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4585 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004586}
4587
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004588/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4589/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004590ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004591Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004592 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4593 if (!E)
4594 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004595
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004596 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004597
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004598 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004599 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4600 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004601
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004602 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4603
4604 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004605}
4606
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004607ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004608Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004609 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004610 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004611 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004612 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004613 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004614
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004615 // Check for an altivec literal,
4616 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004617 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4618 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4619 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4620 return ExprError();
4621 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004622 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4623 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4624 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4625 }
4626 else
4627 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4628 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004629
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004630 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4631 // then handle it as such.
4632 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004633 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4634 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4635 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4636
4637 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4638 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004639 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4640 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004641 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4642 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004643 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004644 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004645 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004646 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004647 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004648 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4649 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004650 }
4651}
4652
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004653ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004654 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004655 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004656 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004657 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4658 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004659 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4660 Expr *expr;
4661 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4662 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4663 else
4664 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004665 return Owned(expr);
4666}
4667
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004668/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4669/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004670/// C99 6.5.15
4671QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004672 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004673 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00004674 // If both LHS and RHS are overloaded functions, try to resolve them.
4675 if (Context.hasSameType(LHS->getType(), RHS->getType()) &&
4676 LHS->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Overload)) {
4677 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, QuestionLoc);
4678 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
4679 return QualType();
4680
4681 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, QuestionLoc);
4682 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
4683 return QualType();
4684
4685 LHS = LHSResult.take();
4686 RHS = RHSResult.take();
4687 }
4688
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004689 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4690 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004691 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004692
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004693 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004694 if (SAVE) {
4695 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4696 }
4697 else
4698 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004699 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4700 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4701 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4702 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004703
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004704 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004705 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004706 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4707 // Throw an error if its not either.
4708 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4709 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4710 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4711 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4712 << CondTy;
4713 return QualType();
4714 }
4715 }
4716 else {
4717 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4718 << CondTy;
4719 return QualType();
4720 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004721 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004722
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004723 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004724 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4725 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004726
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004727 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4728 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4729 // built in select.
4730 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4731 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4732 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4733 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4734 << CondTy;
4735 return QualType();
4736 }
4737 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4738 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4739 << CondTy;
4740 return QualType();
4741 }
4742 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4743 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4744 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4745 }
4746
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004747 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4748 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004749 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4750 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4751 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004752 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004753
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004754 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4755 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004756 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4757 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004758 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004759 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004760 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004761 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004762 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004763 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004764
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004765 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004766 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004767 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4768 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4769 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4770 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4771 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4772 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4773 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004774 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4775 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004776 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004777 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004778 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4779 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004780 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004781 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004782 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004783 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_NullToPointer);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004784 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004785 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004786 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004787 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004788 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_NullToPointer);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004789 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004790 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004791
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004792 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4793 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4794 QuestionLoc);
4795 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4796 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004797
4798
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004799 // Handle block pointer types.
4800 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4801 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4802 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4803 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004804 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4805 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004806 return destType;
4807 }
4808 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004809 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004810 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004811 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004812 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4813 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4814 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004815 return LHSTy;
4816 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004817 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004818 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4819 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004820
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004821 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4822 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004823 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004824 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004825 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4826 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4827 // to get a consistent AST.
4828 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004829 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4830 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004831 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004832 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004833 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004834 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4835 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004836 return LHSTy;
4837 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004838
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004839 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4840 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4841 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004842 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4843 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004844
4845 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4846 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4847 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004848 QualType destPointee
4849 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004850 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004851 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004852 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004853 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004854 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004855 return destType;
4856 }
4857 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004858 QualType destPointee
4859 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004860 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004861 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004862 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004863 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004864 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004865 return destType;
4866 }
4867
4868 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4869 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4870 return LHSTy;
4871 }
4872 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4873 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4874 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4875 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4876 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4877 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4878 // to get a consistent AST.
4879 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004880 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4881 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004882 return incompatTy;
4883 }
4884 // The pointer types are compatible.
4885 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4886 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4887 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4888 // type.
4889 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4890 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004891 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4892 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004893 return LHSTy;
4894 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004895
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004896 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that
4897 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004898 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4899 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4900 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004901 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004902 return RHSTy;
4903 }
4904 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4905 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4906 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004907 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004908 return LHSTy;
4909 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004910
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004911 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004912 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4913 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004914 return QualType();
4915}
4916
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004917/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4918/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4919QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4920 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4921 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4922 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004923
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004924 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4925 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4926 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4927 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4928 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004929 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004930 return LHSTy;
4931 }
4932 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4933 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004934 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004935 return RHSTy;
4936 }
4937 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4938 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4939 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004940 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004941 return LHSTy;
4942 }
4943 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4944 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004945 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004946 return RHSTy;
4947 }
4948 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4949 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4950 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004951 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004952 return LHSTy;
4953 }
4954 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4955 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004956 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004957 return RHSTy;
4958 }
4959 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4960 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004961
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004962 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4963 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4964 return LHSTy;
4965 }
4966 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4967 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4968 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004969
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004970 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4971 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4972 // type. This allows
4973 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4974 // where B is a subclass of A.
4975 //
4976 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4977 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4978 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4979 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004980
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004981 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4982 // It could return the composite type.
4983 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4984 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4985 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4986 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4987 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4988 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4989 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4990 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4991 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4992 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4993 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4994 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4995 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4996 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004997 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004998 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4999 ;
5000 else {
5001 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
5002 << LHSTy << RHSTy
5003 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
5004 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005005 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5006 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005007 return incompatTy;
5008 }
5009 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005010 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
5011 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005012 return compositeType;
5013 }
5014 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
5015 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
5016 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5017 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5018 QualType destPointee
5019 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
5020 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5021 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005022 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005023 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005024 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005025 return destType;
5026 }
5027 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
5028 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5029 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5030 QualType destPointee
5031 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
5032 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5033 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005034 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005035 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005036 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005037 return destType;
5038 }
5039 return QualType();
5040}
5041
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00005042/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005043/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00005044ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005045 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005046 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
5047 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00005048 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
5049 // was the condition.
5050 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00005051 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
5052 if (isLHSNull) {
5053 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
5054 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005055
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00005056 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
5057 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005058 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005059 return ExprError();
5060
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00005061 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00005062 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
5063 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
5064 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005065}
5066
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005067// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005068// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005069// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
5070// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
5071// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005072Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005073Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
5074 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005075
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005076 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5077 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
5078 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5079 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
5080 return Compatible;
5081 }
5082
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005083 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005084 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5085 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005086
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005087 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005088 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5089 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005090
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005091 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005092
5093 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
5094 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
5095 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00005096 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005097 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005098 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005099
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005100 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
5101 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005102 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005103 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005104 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005105 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005106
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005107 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005108 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
5109 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005110 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005111
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005112 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005113 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005114 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005115
5116 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005117 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
5118 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005119 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005120 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005121 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005122 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
5123 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
5124 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
5125 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
5126 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
5127 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005128 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005129 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005130 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005131 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005132
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005133 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005134 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005135 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005136 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005137
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005138 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
5139 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
5140 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
5141 // warning can be disabled.
5142 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
5143 return ConvTy;
5144 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
5145 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005146
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005147 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
5148 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
5149 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
5150 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
5151 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
5152 do {
5153 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5154 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005155
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005156 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5157 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
5158 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005159
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005160 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00005161 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005162 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005163
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005164 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005165 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005166 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005167 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005168}
5169
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005170/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
5171/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
5172/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
5173// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005174Sema::AssignConvertType
5175Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005176 QualType rhsType) {
5177 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005178
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005179 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005180 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5181 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005182
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005183 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
5184 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5185 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005186
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005187 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005188
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005189 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005190 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005191 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005192
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00005193 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5194 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
5195 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
5196 }
5197 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005198 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005199 return ConvTy;
5200}
5201
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005202/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
5203/// for assignment compatibility.
5204Sema::AssignConvertType
5205Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005206 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
5207 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00005208 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5209 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005210 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005211 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005212 }
5213 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
5214 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00005215 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5216 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005217 return IncompatiblePointer;
5218 return Compatible;
5219 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005220 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005221 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005222 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005223 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5224 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
5225 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5226 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
5227 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
5228 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005229
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005230 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
5231 return Compatible;
5232 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
5233 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005234 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005235}
5236
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005237Sema::AssignConvertType
5238Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
5239 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what
5240 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints
5241 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't
5242 // usually happen on valid code.
5243 OpaqueValueExpr rhs(rhsType, VK_RValue);
5244 Expr *rhsPtr = &rhs;
5245 CastKind K = CK_Invalid;
5246
5247 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rhsPtr, K);
5248}
5249
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005250/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
5251/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005252/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
5253///
5254/// int a, *pint;
5255/// short *pshort;
5256/// struct foo *pfoo;
5257///
5258/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5259/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
5260/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
5261/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5262///
5263/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005264/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005265///
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005266/// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible.
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005267Sema::AssignConvertType
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005268Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rhs,
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005269 CastKind &Kind) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005270 QualType rhsType = rhs->getType();
5271
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005272 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
5273 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005274 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
5275 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005276
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005277 if (lhsType == rhsType) {
5278 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00005279 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005280 }
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00005281
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005282 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5283 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
5284 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5285 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005286 Kind = CK_BitCast;
5287 return Compatible;
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005288 }
5289
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005290 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
5291 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
5292 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
5293 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
5294 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
5295 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
5296 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005297 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005298 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType)) {
5299 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast;
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00005300 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005301 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005302 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00005303 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005304 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
5305 // to the same ExtVector type.
5306 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5307 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005308 return Incompatible;
5309 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType()) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005310 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the
5311 // element type.
5312 QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(lhsType)->getElementType();
5313 if (elType != rhsType) {
5314 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, rhs, elType);
5315 ImpCastExprToType(rhs, elType, Kind);
5316 }
5317 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005318 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005319 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005320 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005321
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005322 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005323 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
5324 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5325 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
5326 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5327 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005328 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))) {
John McCall0c6d28d2010-11-15 10:08:00 +00005329 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005330 return IncompatibleVectors;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005331 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005332
5333 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
5334 // vector type and vice versa
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005335 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall0c6d28d2010-11-15 10:08:00 +00005336 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005337 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005338 }
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00005339 }
5340 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005341 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005342
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00005343 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005344 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005345 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, rhs, lhsType);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005346 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005347 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005348
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005349 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005350 if (rhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5351 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null?
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005352 return IntToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005353 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005354
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005355 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
5356 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005357 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005358 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005359
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005360 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005361 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005362 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005363 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5364 return Compatible;
5365 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005366 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005367 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005368 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5369 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005370 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005371 }
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005372
5373 // Treat block pointers as objects.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005374 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType()) {
5375 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005376 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005377 }
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005378 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005379 return Incompatible;
5380 }
5381
5382 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005383 if (rhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5384 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00005385 return IntToBlockPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005386 }
5387
5388 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005389
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005390 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005391 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005392 return Compatible;
5393
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005394 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5395 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005396
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005397 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005398 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005399 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005400
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005401 return Incompatible;
5402 }
5403
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005404 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005405 if (rhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5406 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005407 return IntToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005408 }
5409
5410 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005411
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005412 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005413 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005414 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5415 return Compatible;
5416 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005417 }
5418 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005419 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005420 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005421 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005422 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
5423 return Compatible;
5424 }
5425 // Treat block pointers as objects.
5426 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5427 return Compatible;
5428 return Incompatible;
5429 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005430 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005431 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005432 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy) {
5433 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005434 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005435 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005436
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005437 if (lhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5438 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005439 return PointerToInt;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005440 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005441
5442 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005443 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5444 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005445 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005446 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005447 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005448 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005449 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
5450 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005451 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy) {
5452 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005453 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005454 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005455
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005456 if (lhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5457 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005458 return PointerToInt;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005459 }
5460
5461 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005462
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005463 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005464 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005465 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5466 return Compatible;
5467 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005468 }
5469 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005470 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5471 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005472 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005473 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005474 return Incompatible;
5475 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005476
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005477 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005478 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType)) {
5479 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005480 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005481 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005482 }
5483 return Incompatible;
5484}
5485
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005486/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5487/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005488static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005489 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5490 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5491 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005492 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005493 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005494 SourceLocation());
5495 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5496 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5497
5498 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5499 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005500 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005501 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005502 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005503}
5504
5505Sema::AssignConvertType
5506Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5507 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5508
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005509 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005510 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5511 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005512 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005513 return Incompatible;
5514
5515 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5516 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5517 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5518 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005519 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5520 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005521 it != itend; ++it) {
5522 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5523 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5524 // 1) void pointer
5525 // 2) null pointer constant
5526 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005527 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005528 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005529 InitField = *it;
5530 break;
5531 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005532
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005533 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005534 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005535 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005536 InitField = *it;
5537 break;
5538 }
5539 }
5540
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005541 Expr *rhs = rExpr;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005542 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005543 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rhs, Kind)
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005544 == Compatible) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005545 ImpCastExprToType(rhs, it->getType(), Kind);
5546 rExpr = rhs;
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005547 InitField = *it;
5548 break;
5549 }
5550 }
5551
5552 if (!InitField)
5553 return Incompatible;
5554
5555 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5556 return Compatible;
5557}
5558
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005559Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005560Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005561 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5562 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5563 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5564 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5565 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005566 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005567 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005568 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005569 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005570 }
5571
5572 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5573 // structures.
5574 }
5575
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005576 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5577 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005578 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5579 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005580 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005581 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005582 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005583 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_NullToPointer);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005584 return Compatible;
5585 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005586
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005587 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005588 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005589 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005590 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005591 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005592 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005593 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005594 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005595
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005596 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005597 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005598 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr, Kind);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005599
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005600 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5601 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005602 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5603 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5604 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5605 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005606 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005607 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context), Kind);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005608 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005609}
5610
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005611QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005612 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005613 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005614 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005615 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005616}
5617
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005618QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005619 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005620 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005621 QualType lhsType =
5622 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5623 QualType rhsType =
5624 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005625
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005626 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005627 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005628 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005629
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005630 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5631 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005632 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005633 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005634 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005635 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005636 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005637 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005638 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005639 return lhsType;
5640 }
5641
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005642 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005643 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005644 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5645 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5646 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5647 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5648 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5649 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005650 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005651 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005652 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005653 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005654
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005655 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5656 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5657 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005658 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005659 return rhsType;
5660 }
5661
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005662 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5663 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5664 bool swapped = false;
5665 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5666 swapped = true;
5667 std::swap(rex, lex);
5668 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5669 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005670
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005671 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005672 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005673 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005674 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005675 int order = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType);
5676 if (order > 0)
5677 ImpCastExprToType(rex, EltTy, CK_IntegralCast);
5678 if (order >= 0) {
5679 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_VectorSplat);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005680 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5681 return lhsType;
5682 }
5683 }
5684 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5685 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005686 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType);
5687 if (order > 0)
5688 ImpCastExprToType(rex, EltTy, CK_FloatingCast);
5689 if (order >= 0) {
5690 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_VectorSplat);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005691 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5692 return lhsType;
5693 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005694 }
5695 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005696
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005697 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005698 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005699 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005700 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005701 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005702}
5703
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005704QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5705 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005706 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005707 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005708
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005709 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005710
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005711 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5712 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5713 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005714
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005715 // Check for division by zero.
5716 if (isDiv &&
5717 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005718 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005719 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005720
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005721 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005722}
5723
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005724QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005725 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005726 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005727 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5728 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005729 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5730 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5731 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005732
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005733 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005734
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005735 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5736 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005737
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005738 // Check for remainder by zero.
5739 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005740 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5741 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005742
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005743 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005744}
5745
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005746QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005747 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005748 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5749 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5750 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5751 return compType;
5752 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005753
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005754 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005755
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005756 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005757 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5758 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5759 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005760 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005761 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005762
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005763 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5764 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005765 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005766 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5767
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005768 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005769
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005770 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005771 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005772
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005773 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5774 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005775 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5776 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005777 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005778 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005779 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005780
5781 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5782 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5783 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005784 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005785 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5786 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5787 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5788 return QualType();
5789 }
5790
5791 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5792 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5793 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005794 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005795 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005796 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005797 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005798 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5799 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005800 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5801 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005802 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005803 return QualType();
5804 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005805 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005806 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005807 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5808 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5809 return QualType();
5810 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005811
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005812 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005813 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5814 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5815 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5816 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5817 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005818 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005819 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5820 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005821 return PExp->getType();
5822 }
5823 }
5824
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005825 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005826}
5827
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005828// C99 6.5.6
5829QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005830 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5831 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5832 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5833 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5834 return compType;
5835 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005836
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005837 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005838
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005839 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005840
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005841 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005842 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5843 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005844 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005845 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005846 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005847
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005848 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005849 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005850 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005851
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005852 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005853
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005854 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5855 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5856 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5857 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5858 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5859 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5860 return QualType();
5861 }
5862
5863 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5864 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5865 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5866 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5867 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005868 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005869 return QualType();
5870 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005871
5872 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5873 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5874 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005875 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005876 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005877 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005878 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005879 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005880
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005881 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005882 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005883 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5884 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5885 return QualType();
5886 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005887
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005888 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005889 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5890 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5891 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5892 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5893 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5894 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005895 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005896 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5897
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005898 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005899 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005900 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005901
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005902 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005903 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005904 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005905
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005906 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5907 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5908 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5909 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5910 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5911 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5912 return QualType();
5913 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005914
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005915 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5916 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5917 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5918 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005919 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005920 return QualType();
5921 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005922
5923 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5924 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5925 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5926 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5927 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005928 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5929 << rex->getSourceRange()
5930 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005931 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005932
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005933 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5934 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5935 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5936 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5937 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5938 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5939 return QualType();
5940 }
5941 } else {
5942 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5943 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5944 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5945 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5946 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5947 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5948 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5949 return QualType();
5950 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005951 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005952
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005953 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5954 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5955 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5956 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5957 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005958 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005959 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005960
5961 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005962 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5963 }
5964 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005965
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005966 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005967}
5968
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005969static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5970 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5971 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5972 return false;
5973}
5974
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005975// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005976QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005977 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005978 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005979 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5980 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005981 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005982
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005983 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5984 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5985 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5986 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5987 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5988 }
5989
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005990 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5991 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5992 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5993
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005994 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5995 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005996 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5997 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5998 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5999 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
6000 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006001 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00006002 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006003 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006004
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006005 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006006
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00006007 // Sanity-check shift operands
6008 llvm::APSInt Right;
6009 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00006010 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
6011 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00006012 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00006013 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
6014 else {
6015 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
6016 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
6017 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
6018 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
6019 }
6020 }
6021
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006022 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006023 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006024}
6025
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006026static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
6027 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
6028 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
6029 return true;
6030 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
6031 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
6032 }
6033 return false;
6034}
6035
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006036// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006037QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006038 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006039 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006040
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00006041 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006042 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006043 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006044
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006045 QualType lType = lex->getType();
6046 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006047
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006048 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00006049 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
6050 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
6051 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006052 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
6053 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
6054 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00006055 //
6056 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
6057 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
6058 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
6059 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
6060 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
6061 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006062 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
6063 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006064 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006065 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00006066 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006067 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006068 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6069 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006070 << (Opc == BO_EQ
6071 || Opc == BO_LE
6072 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006073 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
6074 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
6075 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
6076 // what is it always going to eval to?
6077 char always_evals_to;
6078 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006079 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006080 always_evals_to = 0; // false
6081 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006082 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006083 always_evals_to = 1; // true
6084 break;
6085 default:
6086 // best we can say is 'a constant'
6087 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
6088 break;
6089 }
6090 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6091 << 1 // array
6092 << always_evals_to);
6093 }
6094 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006095 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006096
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006097 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
6098 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
6099 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
6100 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006101
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006102 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
6103 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006104 Expr *literalString = 0;
6105 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006106 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006107 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006108 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006109 literalString = lex;
6110 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00006111 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
6112 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006113 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006114 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006115 literalString = rex;
6116 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
6117 }
6118
6119 if (literalString) {
6120 std::string resultComparison;
6121 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006122 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
6123 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
6124 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
6125 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
6126 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
6127 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006128 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
6129 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006130
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00006131 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
6132 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
6133 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00006134 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006135 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00006136 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006137
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006138 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
6139 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
6140 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
6141 else {
6142 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6143 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
6144 }
6145
6146 lType = lex->getType();
6147 rType = rex->getType();
6148
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006149 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00006150 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006151
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006152 if (isRelational) {
6153 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006154 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006155 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00006156 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006157 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006158 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006159
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006160 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006161 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006162 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006163
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006164 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006165 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006166 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006167 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006168
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006169 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
6170 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00006171 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006172 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006173 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006174 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006175 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006176
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006177 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006178 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
6179 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006180 if (!isRelational &&
6181 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6182 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6183 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006184 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
6185 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006186 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6187 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006188 Diag(Loc,
6189 isSFINAEContext()?
6190 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
6191 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006192 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006193
6194 if (isSFINAEContext())
6195 return QualType();
6196
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006197 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006198 return ResultTy;
6199 }
6200 }
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006201
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006202 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
6203 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
6204 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
6205 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
6206 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
6207 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006208 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006209 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006210 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00006211 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006212 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006213 if (T.isNull()) {
6214 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
6215 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6216 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006217 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006218 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006219 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006220 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006221 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006222 }
6223
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006224 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
6225 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006226 return ResultTy;
6227 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006228 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
6229 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
6230 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
6231 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
6232 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
6233 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
6234 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6235 }
6236 } else if (!isRelational &&
6237 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6238 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6239 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6240 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
6241 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
6242 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6243 }
6244 } else {
6245 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006246 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006247 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006248 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006249 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006250 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006251 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00006252 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006253
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006254 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006255 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
6256 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
6257 return ResultTy;
6258
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006259 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006260 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006261 if (RHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006262 ((lType->isPointerType() || lType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006263 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00006264 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
6265 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006266 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006267 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006268 return ResultTy;
6269 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006270 if (LHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006271 ((rType->isPointerType() || rType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006272 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00006273 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
6274 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006275 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006276 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006277 return ResultTy;
6278 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006279
6280 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006281 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006282 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
6283 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006284 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
6285 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
6286 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
6287 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
6288 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
6289 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
6290 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
6291 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006292 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006293 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00006294 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006295 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006296 if (T.isNull()) {
6297 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006298 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006299 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006300 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006301 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006302 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006303 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006304 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006305 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006306
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006307 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
6308 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006309 return ResultTy;
6310 }
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006311 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006312
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006313 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006314 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006315 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6316 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006317
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006318 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00006319 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006320 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006321 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006322 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006323 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006324 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006325 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006326 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006327 if (!isRelational
6328 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
6329 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006330 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006331 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006332 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006333 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006334 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
6335 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
6336 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006337 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006338 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006339 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006340 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006341
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006342 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00006343 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006344 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
6345 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006346 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006347 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006348 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006349 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006350
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006351 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
6352 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006353 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006354 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00006355 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006356 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006357 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00006358 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006359 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006360 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006361 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
6362 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006363 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006364 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00006365 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00006366 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006367 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
6368 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006369 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006370 bool isError = false;
6371 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
6372 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
6373 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006374 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006375 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006376 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006377 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6378 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
6379 isError = true;
6380 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006381 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006382
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006383 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006384 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00006385 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006386 if (isError)
6387 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006388 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006389
6390 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006391 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
6392 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006393 else
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006394 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
6395 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006396 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006397 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006398
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006399 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006400 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
6401 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006402 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006403 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006404 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006405 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
6406 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006407 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006408 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006409 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006410 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006411}
6412
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006413/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006414/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006415/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
6416/// types.
6417QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006418 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006419 bool isRelational) {
6420 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
6421 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006422 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006423 if (vType.isNull())
6424 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006425
Anton Yartsevaa4fe052010-11-18 03:19:30 +00006426 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e.
6427 // bool for C++, int for C
6428 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec)
6429 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy);
6430
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006431 QualType lType = lex->getType();
6432 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006433
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006434 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
6435 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
6436 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006437 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006438 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
6439 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
6440 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006441 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
6442 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6443 << 0 // self-
6444 << 2 // "a constant"
6445 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006446 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006447
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006448 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006449 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
6450 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006451 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006452 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006453
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006454 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
6455 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
6456 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006457 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006458 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006459
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006460 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006461 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006462 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006463 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00006464 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006465 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6466
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006467 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006468 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006469 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6470}
6471
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006472inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006473 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006474 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6475 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
6476 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6477 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6478
6479 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6480 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00006481
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006482 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006483
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006484 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
6485 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006486 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006487 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006488}
6489
6490inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006491 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6492
6493 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6494 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6495 // is a constant.
6496 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006497 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006498 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006499 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6500 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6501 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6502 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6503 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6504 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6505 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6506 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6507 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006508 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6509 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006510 }
6511 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006512
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006513 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6514 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6515 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006516
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006517 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6518 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006519
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006520 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006521 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006522
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006523 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6524 // non-overloadable operands.
6525
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006526 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6527 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006528 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6529 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6530 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006531 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006532
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006533 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6534 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6535 // The result is a bool.
6536 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006537}
6538
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006539/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6540/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6541/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6542///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006543static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006544 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6545 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6546 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006547 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6548 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6549 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6550
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006551 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006552 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6553 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6554 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6555 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006556 }
6557 }
6558 return false;
6559}
6560
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006561/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6562/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6563static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006564 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006565 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006566 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006567 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6568 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006569 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6570 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006571
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006572 unsigned Diag = 0;
6573 bool NeedType = false;
6574 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006575 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006576 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006577 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6578 NeedType = true;
6579 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006580 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006581 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6582 NeedType = true;
6583 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006584 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006585 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6586 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006587 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6588 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006589 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006590 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6591 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006592 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6593 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006594 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6595 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006596 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006597 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006598 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006599 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006600 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6601 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006602 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006603 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6604 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006605 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6606 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6607 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006608 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6609 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6610 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006611 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6612 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6613 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006614 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006615
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006616 SourceRange Assign;
6617 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6618 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006619 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006620 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006621 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006622 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006623 return true;
6624}
6625
6626
6627
6628// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006629QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6630 SourceLocation Loc,
6631 QualType CompoundType) {
6632 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6633 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006634 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006635
6636 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6637 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006638 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006639 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006640 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006641 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006642 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006643 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006644 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6645 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6646 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006647 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006648 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006649 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006650 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006651
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006652 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6653 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6654 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006655 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006656 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6657 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6658 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006659 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6660 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006661 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006662 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006663 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6664 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6665 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006666 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6667 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006668 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006669 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006670 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006671 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006672 }
6673 } else {
6674 // Compound assignment "x += y"
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00006675 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006676 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006677
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006678 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006679 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006680 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006681
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006682
6683 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6684 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6685 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6686 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6687 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6688 // check.
6689 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006690 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006691 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6692 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6693 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6694 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6695 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6696 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6697 }
6698
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006699 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6700 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006701 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006702 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6703 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006704 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006705 // operand.
John McCall2bf6f492010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006706 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6707 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006708}
6709
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006710// C99 6.5.17
6711QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006712 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6713
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00006714 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, Loc);
6715 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
6716 return QualType();
6717
6718 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, Loc);
6719 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
6720 return QualType();
6721 RHS = RHSResult.take();
6722
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006723 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6724 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6725 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6726 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6727 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6728 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6729 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006730
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006731 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6732 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6733 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6734 }
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006735
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006736 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006737}
6738
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006739/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6740/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006741QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006742 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006743 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6744 return Context.DependentTy;
6745
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006746 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6747 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006748
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006749 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6750 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6751 if (!isInc) {
6752 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6753 return QualType();
6754 }
6755 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6756 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6757 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006758 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006759 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6760 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006761
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006762 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006763 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006764 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6765 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6766 << Op->getSourceRange();
6767 return QualType();
6768 }
6769
6770 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006771 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006772 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006773 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6774 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6775 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6776 return QualType();
6777 }
6778
6779 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006780 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006781 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006782 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006783 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006784 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006785 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006786 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006787 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006788 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6789 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6790 return QualType();
6791 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006792 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006793 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6794 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006795 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006796 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6797 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6798 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6799 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006800 } else {
6801 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006802 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006803 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006804 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006805 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006806 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006807 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006808 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006809 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6810 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6811 // operand.
6812 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6813 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006814}
6815
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006816void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6817 bool copyInit = false;
6818 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6819 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6820 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6821 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6822 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6823 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6824 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6825 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6826 }
6827 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6828 }
6829 else
6830 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6831 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6832 if (copyInit) {
6833 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006834 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006835 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6836 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6837 Owned(Arg));
6838 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006839 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006840 }
6841}
6842
6843
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006844/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006845/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006846/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6847/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6848/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6849/// - &(x) => x
6850/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6851/// - &s.xx => s
6852/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6853/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6854/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6855/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006856static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006857 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006858 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006859 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006860 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006861 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6862 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6863 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006864 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006865 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006866 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006867 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006868 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006869 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6870 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006871 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6872 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6873 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6874 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6875 }
6876 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006877 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006878 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6879 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006880
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006881 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006882 case UO_Real:
6883 case UO_Imag:
6884 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006885 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6886 default:
6887 return 0;
6888 }
6889 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006890 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006891 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006892 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006893 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6894 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006895 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006896 default:
6897 return 0;
6898 }
6899}
6900
6901/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006902/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006903/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006904/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006905/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006906/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006907/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006908QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6909 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006910 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006911 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6912 return Context.OverloadTy;
6913
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006914 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6915 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6916 OrigOp = PR.take();
6917
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006918 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6919 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006920
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006921 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6922 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6923 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006924 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006925 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6926 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6927 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6928 }
6929 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6930 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6931 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006932 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006933 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006934
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006935 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006936 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6937 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6938 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6939 if (isSFINAEContext())
6940 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006941 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006942 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006943 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6944 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6945 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6946
6947 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6948 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6949 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6950 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6951 return QualType();
6952 }
6953 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6954 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6955
6956 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6957 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6958 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6959 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6960
6961 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6962 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6963 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6964 << op->getSourceRange();
6965 }
6966
6967 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6968 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6969 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006970 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006971 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006972 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006973 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006974 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6975 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006976 return QualType();
6977 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006978 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006979 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6980 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6981 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006982 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006983 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006984 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006985 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006986 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006987 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006988 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6989 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6990 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6991 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6992 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006993 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6994 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006995 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6996 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006997 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006998 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006999 // with the register storage-class specifier.
7000 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00007001 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
7002 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00007003 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00007004 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007005 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
7006 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007007 return QualType();
7008 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007009 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007010 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007011 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00007012 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007013 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
7014 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00007015 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007016 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007017 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
7018 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007019 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007020 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
7021 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
7022 return QualType();
7023 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007024
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007025 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
7026 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007027 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007028 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00007029 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007030 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007031 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007032
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007033 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
7034 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
7035 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
7036 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
7037 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
7038 }
7039
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007040 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00007041 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
7042 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007043 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
7044}
7045
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007046/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00007047QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007048 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
7049 return Context.DependentTy;
7050
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00007051 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007052 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
7053 QualType Result;
7054
7055 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
7056 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
7057 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
7058 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
7059 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7060 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
7061 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
7062 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
7063 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007064 else {
7065 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
7066 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
7067 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
7068 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007069
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007070 if (Result.isNull()) {
7071 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
7072 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
7073 return QualType();
7074 }
7075
7076 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007077}
7078
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007079static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007080 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007081 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007082 switch (Kind) {
7083 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007084 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
7085 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
7086 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
7087 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
7088 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
7089 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
7090 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
7091 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
7092 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
7093 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
7094 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
7095 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
7096 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
7097 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
7098 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
7099 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
7100 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
7101 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
7102 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
7103 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
7104 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
7105 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
7106 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
7107 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
7108 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
7109 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
7110 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
7111 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
7112 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
7113 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
7114 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
7115 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007116 }
7117 return Opc;
7118}
7119
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007120static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007121 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007122 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007123 switch (Kind) {
7124 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007125 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
7126 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
7127 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
7128 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
7129 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
7130 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
7131 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
7132 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
7133 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
7134 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
7135 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007136 }
7137 return Opc;
7138}
7139
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007140/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
7141/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
7142/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007143ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007144 unsigned Op,
7145 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007146 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007147 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007148 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
7149 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
7150 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007151
7152 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007153 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007154 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
7155 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007156 case BO_PtrMemD:
7157 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00007158 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007159 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00007160 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007161 case BO_Mul:
7162 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00007163 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007164 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007165 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007166 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007167 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7168 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007169 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007170 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7171 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007172 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007173 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7174 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007175 case BO_Shl:
7176 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007177 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7178 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007179 case BO_LE:
7180 case BO_LT:
7181 case BO_GE:
7182 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00007183 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007184 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007185 case BO_EQ:
7186 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00007187 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007188 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007189 case BO_And:
7190 case BO_Xor:
7191 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007192 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7193 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007194 case BO_LAnd:
7195 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00007196 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007197 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007198 case BO_MulAssign:
7199 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00007200 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007201 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007202 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7203 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7204 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007205 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007206 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007207 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7208 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7209 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7210 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007211 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007212 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007213 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7214 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7215 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007216 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007217 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007218 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7219 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7220 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007221 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007222 case BO_ShlAssign:
7223 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007224 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7225 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7226 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7227 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007228 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007229 case BO_AndAssign:
7230 case BO_XorAssign:
7231 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007232 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7233 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7234 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7235 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007236 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007237 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007238 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7239 break;
7240 }
7241 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00007242 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00007243 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007244 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00007245 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
7246 << ResultTy;
7247 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007248 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007249 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
7250 else
7251 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007252 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
7253 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007254}
7255
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007256/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
7257/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007258static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
7259 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007260 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
7261 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
7262 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007263 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007264 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
7265
7266 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
7267 return;
7268
7269 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
7270 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
7271 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007272 return;
7273 }
7274
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007275 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
7276 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007277 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007278
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007279 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007280 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007281
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007282 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
7283 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
7284 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
7285 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007286 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007287 return;
7288 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007289
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007290 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007291 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
7292 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007293}
7294
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007295/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
7296/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
7297/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
7298/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007299static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007300 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007301 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
7302 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
7303 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
7304 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007305 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007306 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007307 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
7308
7309 // Subs are not binary operators.
7310 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
7311 return;
7312
7313 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
7314 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007315 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
7316 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007317 return;
7318
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007319 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007320 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007321 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007322 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
7323 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007324 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007325 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007326 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
7327 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
7328 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
7329 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007330 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007331 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007332 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007333 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
7334 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007335 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007336 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007337 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
7338 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
7339 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
7340 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007341}
7342
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007343/// \brief It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one.
7344/// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression
7345/// in parentheses.
7346static void
7347EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7348 Expr *E) {
7349 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(E) &&
7350 cast<BinaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd);
7351 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
7352 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or)
7353 << E->getSourceRange(),
7354 Self.PDiag(diag::note_logical_and_in_logical_or_silence),
7355 E->getSourceRange(),
7356 Self.PDiag(0), SourceRange());
7357}
7358
7359/// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
7360/// 'true'.
7361static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
7362 bool Res;
7363 return E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res;
7364}
7365
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007366/// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
7367/// 'false'.
7368static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
7369 bool Res;
7370 return E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res;
7371}
7372
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007373/// \brief Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr.
7374static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007375 Expr *OrLHS, Expr *OrRHS) {
7376 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrLHS)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007377 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007378 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7379 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, OrRHS))
7380 return;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007381 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7382 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS()))
7383 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
7384 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) {
7385 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) {
7386 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for
7387 // "a || b && 1", but warn now.
7388 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS()))
7389 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop);
7390 }
7391 }
7392 }
7393}
7394
7395/// \brief Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr.
7396static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007397 Expr *OrLHS, Expr *OrRHS) {
7398 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrRHS)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007399 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007400 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7401 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, OrLHS))
7402 return;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007403 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7404 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS()))
7405 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007406 }
7407 }
7408}
7409
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007410/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007411/// precedence.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007412static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007413 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007414 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007415 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007416 return DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
7417
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007418 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
7419 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd92ccaa2010-11-17 18:54:22 +00007420 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007421 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
7422 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007423 }
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007424}
7425
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007426// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007427ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007428 tok::TokenKind Kind,
7429 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
7430 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00007431 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
7432 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007433
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007434 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
7435 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
7436
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007437 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
7438}
7439
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007440ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007441 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
7442 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007443 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007444 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
7445 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00007446 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007447 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007448 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
7449 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7450 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7451 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7452 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007453 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007454 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007455 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7456 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
7457 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007458
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007459 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
7460 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007461 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00007462 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007463
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007464 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007465 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007466}
7467
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007468ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007469 unsigned OpcIn,
7470 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007471 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007472
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007473 QualType resultType;
7474 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007475 case UO_PreInc:
7476 case UO_PreDec:
7477 case UO_PostInc:
7478 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00007479 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007480 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
7481 Opc == UO_PostInc,
7482 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
7483 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007484 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007485 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007486 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
7487 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007488 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007489 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007490 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
7491 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007492 case UO_Plus:
7493 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007494 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7495 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007496 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7497 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00007498 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7499 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007500 break;
7501 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
7502 resultType->isEnumeralType())
7503 break;
7504 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007505 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007506 resultType->isPointerType())
7507 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007508 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7509 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7510 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7511 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7512 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007513
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007514 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7515 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007516 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007517 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7518 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007519 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7520 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00007521 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
7522 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
7523 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007524 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007525 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007526 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7527 break;
7528 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7529 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7530 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7531 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7532 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007533 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7534 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007535 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007536 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007537 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007538 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007539 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007540 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007541 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7542 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007543 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7544 // ok, fallthrough
7545 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7546 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7547 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7548 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7549 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007550 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7551 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007552 }
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00007553
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007554 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007555 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
7556 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007557 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007558 case UO_Real:
7559 case UO_Imag:
7560 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00007561 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007562 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007563 resultType = Input->getType();
7564 break;
7565 }
7566 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007567 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007568
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007569 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007570}
7571
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007572ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007573 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7574 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007575 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007576 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007577 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7578 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7579 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7580 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007581 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007582 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007583 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7584 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7585 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007586
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007587 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007588 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007589
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007590 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007591}
7592
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007593// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007594ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007595 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7596 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007597}
7598
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007599/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007600ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007601 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7602 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007603 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007604 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007605
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007606 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7607 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007608 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007609 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007610
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007611 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007612 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007613 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7614 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007615}
7616
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007617ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007618Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007619 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007620 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7621 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7622
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007623 bool isFileScope
7624 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007625 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007626 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007627
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007628 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7629 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7630 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007631
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007632 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7633 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7634 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007635 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007636 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7637 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007638 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007639 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007640 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
7641 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007642 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007643 }
7644 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bdc4462010-10-27 20:44:00 +00007645 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LastExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007646 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007647 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
7648 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
7649 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
7650 Ty,
7651 false),
7652 SourceLocation(),
7653 Owned(LastExpr));
7654 if (Res.isInvalid())
7655 return ExprError();
7656 if ((LastExpr = Res.takeAs<Expr>())) {
7657 if (!LastLabelStmt)
7658 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr);
7659 else
7660 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr);
7661 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
7662 }
7663 }
7664 }
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007665 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007666
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007667 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7668 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007669 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
7670 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
7671 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
7672 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007673}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007674
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007675ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007676 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7677 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7678 unsigned NumComponents,
7679 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007680 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007681 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007682 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007683
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007684 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7685 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7686 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007687 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007688 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7689 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7690
7691 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7692 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7693 if (!Dependent
7694 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7695 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7696 << TypeRange))
7697 return ExprError();
7698
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007699 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7700 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007701 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7702 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007703 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007704 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7705 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007706
7707 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7708 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7709 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7710 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7711 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7712 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7713 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7714 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7715 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7716 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7717 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7718 if(!AT)
7719 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7720 << CurrentType);
7721 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7722 } else
7723 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7724
7725 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7726 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7727 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7728 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7729 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7730 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7731 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7732 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7733
7734 // Record this array index.
7735 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7736 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7737 continue;
7738 }
7739
7740 // Offset of a field.
7741 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7742 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7743 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7744 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7745 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7746 continue;
7747 }
7748
7749 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7750 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7751 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7752 return ExprError();
7753
7754 // Look for the designated field.
7755 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7756 if (!RC)
7757 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7758 << CurrentType);
7759 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7760
7761 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7762 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7763 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7764 // (clause 9).
7765 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7766 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7767 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7768 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7769 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7770 << CurrentType))
7771 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7772 }
7773
7774 // Look for the field.
7775 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7776 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7777 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7778 if (!MemberDecl)
7779 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7780 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7781 OC.LocEnd));
7782
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007783 // C99 7.17p3:
7784 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7785 //
7786 // We diagnose this as an error.
7787 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7788 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7789 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7790 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7791 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7792 return ExprError();
7793 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007794
7795 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7796 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7797 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7798 do {
7799 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7800 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7801 }
7802
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007803 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7804 // the base class indirections.
7805 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7806 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007807 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007808 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7809 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7810 B != BEnd; ++B)
7811 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7812 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007813
7814 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007815 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7816 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7817 unsigned n = Path.size();
7818 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7819 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7820 } else {
7821 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7822 }
7823 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7824 }
7825
7826 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7827 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7828 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7829}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007830
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007831ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007832 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7833 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7834 ParsedType argty,
7835 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7836 unsigned NumComponents,
7837 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7838
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007839 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7840 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7841 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7842 return ExprError();
7843
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007844 if (!ArgTInfo)
7845 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7846
7847 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7848 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007849}
7850
7851
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007852ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007853 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7854 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007855 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7856 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7857 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7858 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007859
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007860 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007861
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007862 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7863}
7864
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007865ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007866Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7867 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7868 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7869 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007870 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7871 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7872 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7873 return ExprError();
7874 }
7875
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007876 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007877 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007878}
7879
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007880
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007881ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007882 Expr *CondExpr,
7883 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7884 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007885 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7886
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007887 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007888 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007889 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007890 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007891 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007892 } else {
7893 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7894 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7895 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7896 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007897 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7898 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7899 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007900
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007901 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7902 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007903 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7904 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007905 }
7906
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007907 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007908 resType, RPLoc,
7909 resType->isDependentType(),
7910 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007911}
7912
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007913//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7914// Clang Extensions.
7915//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7916
7917/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007918void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007919 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7920 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7921 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007922 if (BlockScope)
7923 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7924 else
7925 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007926}
7927
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007928void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007929 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007930 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007931
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007932 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007933 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007934 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007935
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007936 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007937 QualType RetTy;
7938 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007939 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007940 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007941 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007942 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7943 } else {
7944 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007945 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007946 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007947
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007948 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007949
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007950 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7951 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7952 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007953 return;
7954 }
7955
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007956 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7957 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7958 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7959 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7960 return;
7961 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007962
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007963 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007964 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7965 // ^ * { ... }
7966 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007967 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7968 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007969
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007970 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007971 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007972 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7973 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7974 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7975 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007976 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7977 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7978 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7979 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7980 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007981 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007982 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007983
7984 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7985 // ^ fntype { ... }
7986 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7987 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7988 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7989 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7990 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7991 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7992 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007993 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007994 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007995 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007996
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007997 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007998 if (!Params.empty()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007999 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00008000 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
8001 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
8002 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
8003 }
8004
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008005 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00008006 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008007
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008008 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008009 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
8010 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
8011 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
8012 }
8013
8014 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
8015 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008016 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008017 return;
8018
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008019 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
8020 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
8021
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008022 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00008023 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
8024 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
8025
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008026 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008027 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
8028 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
8029 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
8030
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008031 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008032 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00008033 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008034}
8035
8036/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
8037/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
8038void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008039 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00008040 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008041 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008042}
8043
8044/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
8045/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008046ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008047 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00008048 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
8049 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
8050 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008051
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008052 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00008053
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008054 PopDeclContext();
8055
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008056 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00008057 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
8058 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008059
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00008060 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008061 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008062
8063 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
8064 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
8065 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
8066
8067 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
8068 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
8069
8070 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
8071 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
8072 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
8073 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
8074
8075 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
8076 // preserve its sugar structure.
8077 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
8078 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
8079 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
8080
8081 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
8082 } else {
8083 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
8084 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
8085 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
8086 FPT->getNumArgs(),
8087 FPT->isVariadic(),
8088 /*quals*/ 0,
8089 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
8090 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
8091 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
8092 FPT->exception_begin(),
8093 Ext);
8094 }
8095
8096 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
8097 } else {
8098 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
8099 false, false, 0, 0,
8100 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
8101 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008102
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008103 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
8104 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008105 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008106
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00008107 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00008108 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008109 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008110
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008111 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008112
8113 bool Good = true;
8114 // Check goto/label use.
8115 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
8116 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8117 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
8118
8119 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
8120 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00008121 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
8122 if (!L->isUsed())
8123 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008124 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00008125 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008126
8127 // Emit error.
8128 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
8129 Good = false;
8130 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008131 if (!Good) {
8132 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008133 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008134 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008135
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00008136 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
8137 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
8138
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00008139 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00008140 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
8141 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00008142 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00008143
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008144 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008145 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008146}
8147
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008148ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00008149 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008150 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008151 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
8152 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008153 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008154}
8155
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008156ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008157 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008158 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00008159 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008160
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008161 // Get the va_list type
8162 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008163 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
8164 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
8165 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
8166 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008167 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008168 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
8169 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
8170 } else {
8171 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
8172 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008173 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008174 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008175 return ExprError();
8176 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008177
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008178 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
8179 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008180 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
8181 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00008182 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00008183 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008184
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00008185 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00008186 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008187
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008188 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8189 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00008190}
8191
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008192ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008193 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
8194 // pointers on the target.
8195 QualType Ty;
8196 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
8197 Ty = Context.IntTy;
8198 else
8199 Ty = Context.LongTy;
8200
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008201 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008202}
8203
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008204static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008205 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008206 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
8207 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008208
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008209 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8210 if (!PT)
8211 return;
8212
8213 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
8214 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
8215 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
8216 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
8217 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
8218 return;
8219 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008220
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008221 // Strip off any parens and casts.
8222 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
8223 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
8224 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008225
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008226 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008227}
8228
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008229bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
8230 SourceLocation Loc,
8231 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00008232 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
8233 bool *Complained) {
8234 if (Complained)
8235 *Complained = false;
8236
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008237 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
8238 bool isInvalid = false;
8239 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008240 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008241
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008242 switch (ConvTy) {
8243 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
8244 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008245 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008246 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
8247 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008248 case IntToPointer:
8249 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
8250 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008251 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008252 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008253 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
8254 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00008255 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
8256 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
8257 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008258 case FunctionVoidPointer:
8259 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
8260 break;
8261 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00008262 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
8263 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
8264 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
8265 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
8266 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
8267 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
8268 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
8269 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
8270 // C++ semantics.
8271 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
8272 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
8273 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008274 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
8275 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00008276 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00008277 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00008278 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008279 case IntToBlockPointer:
8280 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
8281 break;
8282 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00008283 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008284 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008285 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008286 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008287 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
8288 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
8289 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00008290 case IncompatibleVectors:
8291 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
8292 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008293 case Incompatible:
8294 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
8295 isInvalid = true;
8296 break;
8297 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008298
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008299 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
8300 switch (Action) {
8301 case AA_Assigning:
8302 case AA_Initializing:
8303 // The destination type comes first.
8304 FirstType = DstType;
8305 SecondType = SrcType;
8306 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008307
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008308 case AA_Returning:
8309 case AA_Passing:
8310 case AA_Converting:
8311 case AA_Sending:
8312 case AA_Casting:
8313 // The source type comes first.
8314 FirstType = SrcType;
8315 SecondType = DstType;
8316 break;
8317 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008318
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008319 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008320 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00008321 if (Complained)
8322 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008323 return isInvalid;
8324}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008325
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00008326bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008327 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
8328 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
8329 if (Result)
8330 *Result = ICEResult;
8331 return false;
8332 }
8333
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008334 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
8335
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008336 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008337 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
8338 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
8339
8340 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
8341 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
8342 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
8343 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
8344 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
8345 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
8346 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008347
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008348 return true;
8349 }
8350
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008351 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
8352 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008353
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008354 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
8355 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
8356 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008357
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008358 if (Result)
8359 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
8360 return false;
8361}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008362
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008363void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008364Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008365 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
8366 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008367}
8368
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008369void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008370Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
8371 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
8372 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
8373 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008374
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00008375 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
8376 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
8377 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
8378 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
8379 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008380 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00008381 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
8382 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
8383 I != IEnd; ++I)
8384 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
8385 }
8386
8387 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
8388 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
8389 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
8390 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
8391 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
8392 I != IEnd; ++I)
8393 Diag(I->first, I->second);
8394 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008395 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008396
8397 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
8398 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
8399 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
8400 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008401 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008402 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
8403 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
8404 ExprTemporaries.end());
8405
8406 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
8407 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008408}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008409
8410/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
8411///
8412/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
8413/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
8414/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
8415/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
8416///
8417/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
8418///
8419/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
8420void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
8421 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008422
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008423 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008424 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008425
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00008426 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
8427 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
8428 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
8429 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008430 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008431 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +00008432 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008433 return;
8434 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008435
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008436 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
8437 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008438
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008439 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
8440 // an instantiation.
8441 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
8442 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008443
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008444 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008445 case Unevaluated:
8446 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
8447 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008448
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008449 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
8450 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
8451 // "used"; handle this below.
8452 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008453
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008454 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8455 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
8456 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
8457 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008458 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008459 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008460
8461 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
8462 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
8463 // containing expression is used.
8464 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008465 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008466
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008467 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00008468 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00008469 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00008470 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00008471 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
8472 return;
8473 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
8474 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008475 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00008476 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008477 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00008478 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
8479 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008480
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008481 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00008482 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008483 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00008484 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008485 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
8486 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00008487 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
8488 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
8489 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008490 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00008491 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008492 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
8493 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00008494 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00008495 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008496 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00008497 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00008498 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008499 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
8500 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
8501 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
8502 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
8503 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008504 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00008505 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008506 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008507 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008508 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
8509 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
8510 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008511 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00008512 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008513 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
8514 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008515
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008516 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
8517 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
8518 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
8519 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
8520 Loc));
8521 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008522 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008523 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008524 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
8525 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
8526 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00008527 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008528 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
8529 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008530
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008531 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00008532
8533 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
8534 if (CurContext != Function)
8535 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008536
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008537 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008538 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008539
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008540 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008541 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008542 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008543 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
8544 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
8545 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
8546 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
8547 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
8548 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008549 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008550 }
8551 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008552
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008553 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008554
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008555 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008556 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00008557 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008558}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008559
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008560namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008561 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008562 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008563 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008564 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
8565 Sema &S;
8566 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008567
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008568 public:
8569 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008570
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008571 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008572
8573 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
8574 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008575 };
8576}
8577
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008578bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
8579 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008580 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
8581 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
8582 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008583
8584 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008585}
8586
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008587bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008588 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
8589 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
8590 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00008591 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008592 }
8593
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008594 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008595}
8596
8597void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8598 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008599 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008600}
8601
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008602namespace {
8603 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8604 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8605 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8606 Sema &S;
8607
8608 public:
8609 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8610
8611 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8612
8613 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8614 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8615 }
8616
8617 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8618 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008619 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008620 }
8621
8622 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8623 if (E->getConstructor())
8624 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8625 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8626 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8627 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8628 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008629 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008630 }
8631
8632 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8633 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8634 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008635 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8636 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8637 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8638 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8639 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8640 }
8641
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008642 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008643 }
8644
8645 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8646 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008647 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008648 }
8649
8650 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8651 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8652 }
Douglas Gregor102ff972010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008653
8654 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8655 Visit(E->getExpr());
8656 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008657 };
8658}
8659
8660/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8661/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8662void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8663 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8664}
8665
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008666/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8667/// of the program being compiled.
8668///
8669/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008670/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008671/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8672/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8673/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8674/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008675/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008676/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008677///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008678/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8679/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8680/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8681/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008682bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008683 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8684 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8685 case Unevaluated:
8686 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8687 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008688
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008689 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008690 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008691 Diag(Loc, PD);
8692 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008693
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008694 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8695 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8696 break;
8697 }
8698
8699 return false;
8700}
8701
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008702bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8703 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8704 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8705 return false;
8706
8707 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8708 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8709 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8710 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008711
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008712 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008713 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008714 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8715 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008716 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008717 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8718 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8719 return true;
8720
8721 return false;
8722}
8723
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008724// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8725// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8726void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8727 SourceLocation Loc;
8728
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008729 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8730
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008731 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8732 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008733 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008734 return;
8735
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008736 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8737 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8738 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8739 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8740
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008741 // self = [<foo> init...]
8742 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8743 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8744 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8745
8746 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8747 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8748 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8749 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8750 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008751
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008752 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8753 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8754 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8755 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8756 return;
8757
8758 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8759 } else {
8760 // Not an assignment.
8761 return;
8762 }
8763
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008764 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008765 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008766
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008767 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008768 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008769 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008770 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8771 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8772 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008773}
8774
8775bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8776 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8777
8778 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis11ab7902010-11-01 18:49:26 +00008779 if (E->isBoundMemberFunction(Context))
8780 return Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
8781 << E->getSourceRange();
8782
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008783 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008784
8785 QualType T = E->getType();
8786
8787 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8788 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8789 return true;
8790 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8791 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8792 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8793 return true;
8794 }
8795 }
8796
8797 return false;
8798}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008799
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008800ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8801 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008802 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008803 return ExprError();
8804
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008805 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008806 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008807
8808 return Owned(Sub);
8809}
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008810
8811/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8812/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8813ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8814 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8815 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8816
8817 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8818 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8819 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8820 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8821 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8822 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8823 Specialization->getAccess());
8824 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8825 if (!E) return ExprError();
8826 return Owned(E);
8827 }
8828
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008829 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008830 return ExprError();
8831 }
8832
8833 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8834 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8835
8836 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8837 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8838 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8839 return ExprError();
8840}